formatdomain.html.in 269.2 KB
Newer Older
1 2 3
<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8"?>
<!DOCTYPE html PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN" "http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd">
<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml">
4 5 6
  <body>
    <h1>Domain XML format</h1>

D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32
    <ul id="toc"></ul>

    <p>
      This section describes the XML format used to represent domains, there are
      variations on the format based on the kind of domains run and the options
      used to launch them. For hypervisor specific details consult the
      <a href="drivers.html">driver docs</a>
    </p>


    <h2><a name="elements">Element and attribute overview</a></h2>

    <p>
      The root element required for all virtual machines is
      named <code>domain</code>. It has two attributes, the
      <code>type</code> specifies the hypervisor used for running
      the domain. The allowed values are driver specific, but
      include "xen", "kvm", "qemu", "lxc" and "kqemu". The
      second attribute is <code>id</code> which is a unique
      integer identifier for the running guest machine. Inactive
      machines have no id value.
    </p>


    <h3><a name="elementsMetadata">General metadata</a></h3>

33 34 35 36
<pre>
&lt;domain type='xen' id='3'&gt;
  &lt;name&gt;fv0&lt;/name&gt;
  &lt;uuid&gt;4dea22b31d52d8f32516782e98ab3fa0&lt;/uuid&gt;
37
  &lt;title&gt;A short description - title - of the domain&lt;/title&gt;
38
  &lt;description&gt;Some human readable description&lt;/description&gt;
39 40 41 42
  &lt;metadata&gt;
    &lt;app1:foo xmlns:app1="http://app1.org/app1/"&gt;..&lt;/app1:foo&gt;
    &lt;app2:bar xmlns:app2="http://app1.org/app2/"&gt;..&lt;/app2:bar&gt;
  &lt;/metadata&gt;
43
  ...</pre>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
44 45 46 47

    <dl>
      <dt><code>name</code></dt>
      <dd>The content of the <code>name</code> element provides
M
Matthew Booth 已提交
48 49 50 51 52
        a short name for the virtual machine. This name should
        consist only of alpha-numeric characters and is required
        to be unique within the scope of a single host. It is
        often used to form the filename for storing the persistent
        configuration file. <span class="since">Since 0.0.1</span></dd>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
53 54
      <dt><code>uuid</code></dt>
      <dd>The content of the <code>uuid</code> element provides
M
Matthew Booth 已提交
55
        a globally unique identifier for the virtual machine.
E
Eric Blake 已提交
56 57
        The format must be RFC 4122 compliant,
        eg <code>3e3fce45-4f53-4fa7-bb32-11f34168b82b</code>.
M
Matthew Booth 已提交
58
        If omitted when defining/creating a new machine, a random
59 60 61 62
        UUID is generated. It is also possible to provide the UUID
        via a <a href="#elementsSysinfo"><code>sysinfo</code></a>
        specification. <span class="since">Since 0.0.1, sysinfo
        since 0.8.7</span></dd>
63

64 65 66 67 68
      <dt><code>title</code></dt>
      <dd>The optional element <code>title</code> provides space for a
        short description of the domain. The title should not contain
        any newlines. <span class="since">Since 0.9.10</span>.</dd>

69 70
      <dt><code>description</code></dt>
      <dd>The content of the <code>description</code> element provides a
71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82
        human readable description of the virtual machine. This data is not
        used by libvirt in any way, it can contain any information the user
        wants. <span class="since">Since 0.7.2</span></dd>

      <dt><code>metadata</code></dt>
      <dd>The <code>metadata</code> node can be used by applications
        to store custom metadata in the form of XML
        nodes/trees. Applications must use custom namespaces on their
        XML nodes/trees, with only one top-level element per namespace
        (if the application needs structure, they should have
        sub-elements to their namespace
        element). <span class="since">Since 0.9.10</span></dd>
83
   </dl>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
84 85 86 87 88 89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100

    <h3><a name="elementsOS">Operating system booting</a></h3>

    <p>
      There are a number of different ways to boot virtual machines
      each with their own pros and cons.
    </p>

    <h4><a name="elementsOSBIOS">BIOS bootloader</a></h4>

    <p>
      Booting via the BIOS is available for hypervisors supporting
      full virtualization. In this case the BIOS has a boot order
      priority (floppy, harddisk, cdrom, network) determining where
      to obtain/find the boot image.
    </p>

101 102 103 104
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;os&gt;
    &lt;type&gt;hvm&lt;/type&gt;
105
    &lt;loader readonly='yes' type='rom'&gt;/usr/lib/xen/boot/hvmloader&lt;/loader&gt;
106
    &lt;nvram template='/usr/share/OVMF/OVMF_VARS.fd'&gt;/var/lib/libvirt/nvram/guest_VARS.fd&lt;/nvram&gt;
107
    &lt;boot dev='hd'/&gt;
108
    &lt;boot dev='cdrom'/&gt;
109
    &lt;bootmenu enable='yes' timeout='3000'/&gt;
110
    &lt;smbios mode='sysinfo'/&gt;
111
    &lt;bios useserial='yes' rebootTimeout='0'/&gt;
112 113
  &lt;/os&gt;
  ...</pre>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
114 115 116 117

    <dl>
      <dt><code>type</code></dt>
      <dd>The content of the <code>type</code> element specifies the
M
Matthew Booth 已提交
118 119 120 121 122
        type of operating system to be booted in the virtual machine.
        <code>hvm</code> indicates that the OS is one designed to run
        on bare metal, so requires full virtualization. <code>linux</code>
        (badly named!) refers to an OS that supports the Xen 3 hypervisor
        guest ABI. There are also two optional attributes, <code>arch</code>
E
Eric Blake 已提交
123 124 125 126 127
        specifying the CPU architecture to virtualization,
        and <code>machine</code> referring to the machine
        type. The <a href="formatcaps.html">Capabilities XML</a>
        provides details on allowed values for
        these. <span class="since">Since 0.0.1</span></dd>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
128
      <dt><code>loader</code></dt>
129 130
      <dd>The optional <code>loader</code> tag refers to a firmware blob,
        which is specified by absolute path,
131 132 133
        used to assist the domain creation process. It is used by Xen
        fully virtualized domains as well as setting the QEMU BIOS file
        path for QEMU/KVM domains. <span class="since">Xen since 0.1.0,
134 135 136 137 138 139 140 141 142 143 144 145
        QEMU/KVM since 0.9.12</span> Then, <span class="since">since
        1.2.8</span> it's possible for the element to have two
        optional attributes: <code>readonly</code> (accepted values are
        <code>yes</code> and <code>no</code>) to reflect the fact that the
        image should be writable or read-only. The second attribute
        <code>type</code> accepts values <code>rom</code> and
        <code>pflash</code>. It tells the hypervisor where in the guest
        memory the file should be mapped.  For instance, if the loader
        path points to an UEFI image, <code>type</code> should be
        <code>pflash</code>.</dd>
      <dt><code>nvram</code></dt>
      <dd>Some UEFI firmwares may want to use a non-volatile memory to store
146 147 148 149
        some variables. In the host, this is represented as a file and the
        absolute path to the file is stored in this element. Moreover, when the
        domain is started up libvirt copies so called master NVRAM store file
        defined in <code>qemu.conf</code>. If needed, the <code>template</code>
150
        attribute can be used to per domain override map of master NVRAM stores
151 152 153 154
        from the config file. Note, that for transient domains if the NVRAM file
        has been created by libvirt it is left behind and it is management
        application's responsibility to save and remove file (if needed to be
        persistent). <span class="since">Since 1.2.8</span></dd>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
155 156
      <dt><code>boot</code></dt>
      <dd>The <code>dev</code> attribute takes one of the values "fd", "hd",
M
Matthew Booth 已提交
157 158
        "cdrom" or "network" and is used to specify the next boot device
        to consider. The <code>boot</code> element can be repeated multiple
159 160 161 162 163 164 165 166 167 168 169 170
        times to setup a priority list of boot devices to try in turn.
        Multiple devices of the same type are sorted according to their
        targets while preserving the order of buses. After defining the
        domain, its XML configuration returned by libvirt (through
        virDomainGetXMLDesc) lists devices in the sorted order. Once sorted,
        the first device is marked as bootable. Thus, e.g., a domain
        configured to boot from "hd" with vdb, hda, vda, and hdc disks
        assigned to it will boot from vda (the sorted list is vda, vdb, hda,
        hdc). Similar domain with hdc, vda, vdb, and hda disks will boot from
        hda (sorted disks are: hda, hdc, vda, vdb). It can be tricky to
        configure in the desired way, which is why per-device boot elements
        (see <a href="#elementsDisks">disks</a>,
171
        <a href="#elementsNICS">network interfaces</a>, and
172
        <a href="#elementsHostDev">USB and PCI devices</a> sections below) were
173 174 175 176
        introduced and they are the preferred way providing full control over
        booting order. The <code>boot</code> element and per-device boot
        elements are mutually exclusive. <span class="since">Since 0.1.3,
        per-device boot since 0.8.8</span>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
177
      </dd>
178 179 180 181 182 183 184 185 186 187 188 189 190 191 192 193 194 195 196 197 198 199 200 201 202
      <dt><code>smbios</code></dt>
      <dd>How to populate SMBIOS information visible in the guest.
        The <code>mode</code> attribute must be specified, and is either
        "emulate" (let the hypervisor generate all values), "host" (copy
        all of Block 0 and Block 1, except for the UUID, from the host's
        SMBIOS values;
        the <a href="html/libvirt-libvirt-host.html#virConnectGetSysinfo">
        <code>virConnectGetSysinfo</code></a> call can be
        used to see what values are copied), or "sysinfo" (use the values in
        the <a href="#elementsSysinfo">sysinfo</a> element).  If not
        specified, the hypervisor default is used. <span class="since">
        Since 0.8.7</span>
      </dd>
  </dl>
      <p>Up till here the BIOS/UEFI configuration knobs are generic enough to
      be implemented by majority (if not all) firmwares out there. However,
      from now on not every single setting makes sense to all firmwares. For
      instance, <code>rebootTimeout</code> doesn't make sense for UEFI,
      <code>useserial</code> might not be usable with a BIOS firmware that
      doesn't produce any output onto serial line, etc. Moreover, firmwares
      don't usually export their capabilities for libvirt (or users) to check.
      And the set of their capabilities can change with every new release.
      Hence users are advised to try the settings they use before relying on
      them in production.</p>
  <dl>
203 204 205 206 207
      <dt><code>bootmenu</code></dt>
      <dd> Whether or not to enable an interactive boot menu prompt on guest
      startup. The <code>enable</code> attribute can be either "yes" or "no".
      If not specified, the hypervisor default is used. <span class="since">
      Since 0.8.3</span>
208 209
      Additional attribute <code>timeout</code> takes the number of milliseconds
      the boot menu should wait until it times out.  Allowed values are numbers
210 211
      in range [0, 65535] inclusive and it is ignored unless <code>enable</code>
      is set to "yes". <span class="since">Since 1.2.8</span>
212
      </dd>
M
Michal Privoznik 已提交
213 214 215 216 217 218
      <dt><code>bios</code></dt>
      <dd>This element has attribute <code>useserial</code> with possible
        values <code>yes</code> or <code>no</code>. It enables or disables
        Serial Graphics Adapter which allows users to see BIOS messages
        on a serial port. Therefore, one needs to have
        <a href="#elementCharSerial">serial port</a> defined.
219 220 221 222 223 224 225
        <span class="since">Since 0.9.4</span>.
        <span class="since">Since 0.10.2 (QEMU only)</span> there is
        another attribute, <code>rebootTimeout</code> that controls
        whether and after how long the guest should start booting
        again in case the boot fails (according to BIOS). The value is
        in milliseconds with maximum of <code>65535</code> and special
        value <code>-1</code> disables the reboot.
226
      </dd>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
227 228 229 230 231 232 233
    </dl>

    <h4><a name="elementsOSBootloader">Host bootloader</a></h4>

    <p>
      Hypervisors employing paravirtualization do not usually emulate
      a BIOS, and instead the host is responsible to kicking off the
A
Atsushi SAKAI 已提交
234
      operating system boot. This may use a pseudo-bootloader in the
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
235
      host to provide an interface to choose a kernel for the guest.
236 237 238
      An example is <code>pygrub</code> with Xen. The Bhyve hypervisor
      also uses a host bootloader, either <code>bhyveload</code> or
      <code>grub-bhyve</code>.
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
239 240
    </p>

241 242 243 244 245
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;bootloader&gt;/usr/bin/pygrub&lt;/bootloader&gt;
  &lt;bootloader_args&gt;--append single&lt;/bootloader_args&gt;
  ...</pre>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
246 247 248 249

    <dl>
      <dt><code>bootloader</code></dt>
      <dd>The content of the <code>bootloader</code> element provides
M
Matthew Booth 已提交
250 251 252 253
        a fully qualified path to the bootloader executable in the
        host OS. This bootloader will be run to choose which kernel
        to boot. The required output of the bootloader is dependent
        on the hypervisor in use. <span class="since">Since 0.1.0</span></dd>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
254 255
      <dt><code>bootloader_args</code></dt>
      <dd>The optional <code>bootloader_args</code> element allows
M
Matthew Booth 已提交
256 257 258
        command line arguments to be passed to the bootloader.
        <span class="since">Since 0.2.3</span>
        </dd>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
259 260 261 262 263 264 265 266 267 268 269 270

    </dl>

    <h4><a name="elementsOSKernel">Direct kernel boot</a></h4>

    <p>
      When installing a new guest OS it is often useful to boot directly
      from a kernel and initrd stored in the host OS, allowing command
      line arguments to be passed directly to the installer. This capability
      is usually available for both para and full virtualized guests.
    </p>

271 272 273 274 275 276 277 278
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;os&gt;
    &lt;type&gt;hvm&lt;/type&gt;
    &lt;loader&gt;/usr/lib/xen/boot/hvmloader&lt;/loader&gt;
    &lt;kernel&gt;/root/f8-i386-vmlinuz&lt;/kernel&gt;
    &lt;initrd&gt;/root/f8-i386-initrd&lt;/initrd&gt;
    &lt;cmdline&gt;console=ttyS0 ks=http://example.com/f8-i386/os/&lt;/cmdline&gt;
279
    &lt;dtb&gt;/root/ppc.dtb&lt;/dtb&gt;
280 281
  &lt;/os&gt;
  ...</pre>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
282 283 284 285

    <dl>
      <dt><code>type</code></dt>
      <dd>This element has the same semantics as described earlier in the
M
Matthew Booth 已提交
286
        <a href="#elementsOSBIOS">BIOS boot section</a></dd>
D
Daniel Veillard 已提交
287
      <dt><code>loader</code></dt>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
288
      <dd>This element has the same semantics as described earlier in the
M
Matthew Booth 已提交
289
        <a href="#elementsOSBIOS">BIOS boot section</a></dd>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
290 291
      <dt><code>kernel</code></dt>
      <dd>The contents of this element specify the fully-qualified path
M
Matthew Booth 已提交
292
        to the kernel image in the host OS.</dd>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
293 294
      <dt><code>initrd</code></dt>
      <dd>The contents of this element specify the fully-qualified path
M
Matthew Booth 已提交
295
        to the (optional) ramdisk image in the host OS.</dd>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
296 297
      <dt><code>cmdline</code></dt>
      <dd>The contents of this element specify arguments to be passed to
298
        the kernel (or installer) at boot time. This is often used to
M
Matthew Booth 已提交
299 300
        specify an alternate primary console (eg serial port), or the
        installation media source / kickstart file</dd>
301 302 303 304
      <dt><code>dtb</code></dt>
      <dd>The contents of this element specify the fully-qualified path
        to the (optional) device tree binary (dtb) image in the host OS.
        <span class="since">Since 1.0.4</span></dd>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
305 306
    </dl>

307
    <h4><a name="elementsOSContainer">Container boot</a></h4>
308 309 310 311 312 313 314 315

    <p>
      When booting a domain using container based virtualization, instead
      of a kernel / boot image, a path to the init binary is required, using
      the <code>init</code> element. By default this will be launched with
      no arguments. To specify the initial argv, use the <code>initarg</code>
      element, repeated as many time as is required. The <code>cmdline</code>
      element, if set will be used to provide an equivalent to <code>/proc/cmdline</code>
C
Chen Hanxiao 已提交
316
      but will not affect init argv.
317 318 319 320 321 322 323 324 325 326 327 328
    </p>

    <pre>
  &lt;os&gt;
    &lt;type arch='x86_64'&gt;exe&lt;/type&gt;
    &lt;init&gt;/bin/systemd&lt;/init&gt;
    &lt;initarg&gt;--unit&lt;/initarg&gt;
    &lt;initarg&gt;emergency.service&lt;/initarg&gt;
  &lt;/os&gt;
    </pre>


329
    <p>
330 331
      If you want to enable user namespace, set the <code>idmap</code> element.
      The <code>uid</code> and <code>gid</code> elements have three attributes:
332 333 334 335
    </p>

    <dl>
      <dt><code>start</code></dt>
336
      <dd>First user ID in container. It must be '0'.</dd>
337
      <dt><code>target</code></dt>
338 339
      <dd>The first user ID in container will be mapped to this target user
          ID in host.</dd>
340
      <dt><code>count</code></dt>
341
      <dd>How many users in container are allowed to map to host's user.</dd>
342 343 344 345 346 347 348 349 350 351
    </dl>

    <pre>
  &lt;idmap&gt;
    &lt;uid start='0' target='1000' count='10'/&gt;
    &lt;gid start='0' target='1000' count='10'/&gt;
  &lt;/idmap&gt;
    </pre>


352 353 354 355 356 357 358 359 360 361 362 363 364 365 366 367 368 369 370 371 372 373 374
    <h3><a name="elementsSysinfo">SMBIOS System Information</a></h3>

    <p>
      Some hypervisors allow control over what system information is
      presented to the guest (for example, SMBIOS fields can be
      populated by a hypervisor and inspected via
      the <code>dmidecode</code> command in the guest).  The
      optional <code>sysinfo</code> element covers all such categories
      of information. <span class="since">Since 0.8.7</span>
    </p>

<pre>
  ...
  &lt;os&gt;
    &lt;smbios mode='sysinfo'/&gt;
    ...
  &lt;/os&gt;
  &lt;sysinfo type='smbios'&gt;
    &lt;bios&gt;
      &lt;entry name='vendor'&gt;LENOVO&lt;/entry&gt;
    &lt;/bios&gt;
    &lt;system&gt;
      &lt;entry name='manufacturer'&gt;Fedora&lt;/entry&gt;
375 376
      &lt;entry name='product'&gt;Virt-Manager&lt;/entry&gt;
      &lt;entry name='version'&gt;0.9.4&lt;/entry&gt;
377
    &lt;/system&gt;
378 379 380 381 382 383
    &lt;baseBoard&gt;
      &lt;entry name='manufacturer'&gt;LENOVO&lt;/entry&gt;
      &lt;entry name='product'&gt;20BE0061MC&lt;/entry&gt;
      &lt;entry name='version'&gt;0B98401 Pro&lt;/entry&gt;
      &lt;entry name='serial'&gt;W1KS427111E&lt;/entry&gt;
    &lt;/baseBoard&gt;
384 385 386 387 388 389 390 391 392 393 394 395 396 397 398 399 400 401 402 403 404 405
  &lt;/sysinfo&gt;
  ...</pre>

    <p>
      The <code>sysinfo</code> element has a mandatory
      attribute <code>type</code> that determine the layout of
      sub-elements, with supported values of:
    </p>

    <dl>
      <dt><code>smbios</code></dt>
      <dd>Sub-elements call out specific SMBIOS values, which will
      affect the guest if used in conjunction with
      the <code>smbios</code> sub-element of
      the <a href="#elementsOS"><code>os</code></a> element.  Each
      sub-element of <code>sysinfo</code> names a SMBIOS block, and
      within those elements can be a list of <code>entry</code>
      elements that describe a field within the block.  The following
      blocks and entries are recognized:
        <dl>
          <dt><code>bios</code></dt>
          <dd>
406 407 408 409 410 411 412 413 414 415 416 417 418 419 420
            This is block 0 of SMBIOS, with entry names drawn from:
            <dl>
               <dt><code>vendor</code></dt>
               <dd>BIOS Vendor's Name</dd>
               <dt><code>version</code></dt>
               <dd>BIOS Version</dd>
               <dt><code>date</code></dt>
               <dd>BIOS release date. If supplied, is in either mm/dd/yy or
                   mm/dd/yyyy format. If the year portion of the string is
                   two digits, the year is assumed to be 19yy.</dd>
               <dt><code>release</code></dt>
               <dd>System BIOS Major and Minor release number values
                   concatenated together as one string separated by
                   a period, for example, 10.22.</dd>
           </dl>
421 422 423
          </dd>
          <dt><code>system</code></dt>
          <dd>
424 425 426 427 428 429 430 431 432 433 434 435 436 437 438 439 440 441 442 443
            This is block 1 of SMBIOS, with entry names drawn from:
            <dl>
                <dt><code>manufacturer</code></dt>
                <dd>Manufacturer of BIOS</dd>
                <dt><code>product</code></dt>
                <dd>Product Name</dd>
                <dt><code>version</code></dt>
                <dd>Version of the product</dd>
                <dt><code>serial</code></dt>
                <dd>Serial number</dd>
                <dt><code>uuid</code></dt>
                <dd>Universal Unique ID number. If this entry is provided
                alongside a top-level
                <a href="#elementsMetadata"><code>uuid</code></a> element,
                then the two values must match.</dd>
                <dt><code>sku</code></dt>
                <dd>SKU number to identify a particular configuration.</dd>
                <dt><code>family</code></dt>
                <dd>Identify the family a particular computer belongs to.</dd>
            </dl>
444 445 446 447 448 449 450 451 452 453 454 455 456 457 458 459 460 461 462 463 464 465 466 467 468 469
          </dd>
          <dt><code>baseBoard</code></dt>
          <dd>
            This is block 2 of SMBIOS. This element can be repeated multiple
            times to describe all the base boards; however, not all
            hypervisors necessarily support the repetition. The element can
            have the following children:
            <dl>
                <dt><code>manufacturer</code></dt>
                <dd>Manufacturer of BIOS</dd>
                <dt><code>product</code></dt>
                <dd>Product Name</dd>
                <dt><code>version</code></dt>
                <dd>Version of the product</dd>
                <dt><code>serial</code></dt>
                <dd>Serial number</dd>
                <dt><code>asset</code></dt>
                <dd>Asset tag</dd>
                <dt><code>location</code></dt>
                <dd>Location in chassis</dd>
            </dl>
            NB: Incorrectly supplied entries for the
            <code>bios</code>, <code>system</code> or <code>baseBoard</code>
            blocks will be ignored without error.  Other than <code>uuid</code>
            validation and <code>date</code> format checking, all values are
            passed as strings to the hypervisor driver.
470 471 472 473 474
          </dd>
        </dl>
      </dd>
    </dl>

475
    <h3><a name="elementsCPUAllocation">CPU Allocation</a></h3>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
476

477
<pre>
478
&lt;domain&gt;
479
  ...
O
Osier Yang 已提交
480
  &lt;vcpu placement='static' cpuset="1-4,^3,6" current="1"&gt;2&lt;/vcpu&gt;
481 482 483
  ...
&lt;/domain&gt;
</pre>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
484 485 486

    <dl>
      <dt><code>vcpu</code></dt>
487
      <dd>The content of this element defines the maximum number of virtual
E
Eric Blake 已提交
488
        CPUs allocated for the guest OS, which must be between 1 and
489 490 491 492 493 494 495 496 497 498 499 500 501 502 503 504 505 506 507 508 509 510 511 512 513 514 515 516 517 518 519 520 521 522 523 524 525 526 527 528 529 530 531 532
        the maximum supported by the hypervisor.
        <dl>
         <dt><code>cpuset</code></dt>
         <dd>
           The optional attribute <code>cpuset</code> is a comma-separated
           list of physical CPU numbers that domain process and virtual CPUs
           can be pinned to by default. (NB: The pinning policy of domain
           process and virtual CPUs can be specified separately by
           <code>cputune</code>. If the attribute <code>emulatorpin</code>
           of <code>cputune</code> is specified, the <code>cpuset</code>
           specified by <code>vcpu</code> here will be ignored. Similarly,
           for virtual CPUs which have the <code>vcpupin</code> specified,
           the <code>cpuset</code> specified by <code>cpuset</code> here
           will be ignored. For virtual CPUs which don't have
           <code>vcpupin</code> specified, each will be pinned to the physical
           CPUs specified by <code>cpuset</code> here).
           Each element in that list is either a single CPU number,
           a range of CPU numbers, or a caret followed by a CPU number to
           be excluded from a previous range.
           <span class="since">Since 0.4.4</span>
         </dd>
         <dt><code>current</code></dt>
         <dd>
           The optional attribute <code>current</code> can
           be used to specify whether fewer than the maximum number of
           virtual CPUs should be enabled.
           <span class="since">Since 0.8.5</span>
         </dd>
         <dt><code>placement</code></dt>
         <dd>
           The optional attribute <code>placement</code> can be used to
           indicate the CPU placement mode for domain process. The value can
           be either "static" or "auto", but defaults to <code>placement</code>
           of <code>numatune</code> or "static" if <code>cpuset</code> is
           specified. Using "auto" indicates the domain process will be pinned
           to the advisory nodeset from querying numad and the value of
           attribute <code>cpuset</code> will be ignored if it's specified.
           If both <code>cpuset</code> and <code>placement</code> are not
           specified or if <code>placement</code> is "static", but no
           <code>cpuset</code> is specified, the domain process will be
           pinned to all the available physical CPUs.
           <span class="since">Since 0.9.11 (QEMU and KVM only)</span>
         </dd>
        </dl>
E
Eric Blake 已提交
533
      </dd>
534 535
    </dl>

536 537 538 539 540 541 542 543 544 545 546 547 548 549
    <h3><a name="elementsIOThreadsAllocation">IOThreads Allocation</a></h3>
      <p>
        IOThreads are dedicated event loop threads for supported disk
        devices to perform block I/O requests in order to improve
        scalability especially on an SMP host/guest with many LUNs.
        <span class="since">Since 1.2.8 (QEMU only)</span>
      </p>

<pre>
&lt;domain&gt;
  ...
  &lt;iothreads&gt;4&lt;/iothreads&gt;
  ...
&lt;/domain&gt;
550 551 552 553 554 555 556 557 558 559 560 561
</pre>
<pre>
&lt;domain&gt;
  ...
  &lt;iothreadids&gt;
    &lt;iothread id="2"/&gt;
    &lt;iothread id="4"/&gt;
    &lt;iothread id="6"/&gt;
    &lt;iothread id="8"/&gt;
  &lt;/iothreadids&gt;
  ...
&lt;/domain&gt;
562 563 564 565 566 567 568
</pre>

    <dl>
      <dt><code>iothreads</code></dt>
      <dd>
        The content of this optional element defines the number
        of IOThreads to be assigned to the domain for use by
569 570 571
        virtio-blk-pci and virtio-blk-ccw target storage devices. There
        should be only 1 or 2 IOThreads per host CPU. There may be more
        than one supported device assigned to each IOThread.
572
        <span class="since">Since 1.2.8</span>
573
      </dd>
574 575 576 577 578 579 580 581 582 583 584 585 586 587 588 589 590
      <dt><code>iothreadids</code></dt>
      <dd>
        The optional <code>iothreadids</code> element provides the capability
        to specifically define the IOThread ID's for the domain.  By default,
        IOThread ID's are sequentially numbered starting from 1 through the
        number of <code>iothreads</code> defined for the domain. The
        <code>id</code> attribute is used to define the IOThread ID. The
        <code>id</code> attribute must be a positive integer greater than 0.
        If there are less <code>iothreadids</code> defined than
        <code>iothreads</code> defined for the domain, then libvirt will
        sequentially fill <code>iothreadids</code> starting at 1 avoiding
        any predefined <code>id</code>. If there are more
        <code>iothreadids</code> defined than <code>iothreads</code>
        defined for the domain, then the <code>iothreads</code> value
        will be adjusted accordingly.
        <span class="since">Since 1.2.15</span>
       </dd>
591
    </dl>
592 593 594 595 596 597 598 599 600 601 602

    <h3><a name="elementsCPUTuning">CPU Tuning</a></h3>

<pre>
&lt;domain&gt;
  ...
  &lt;cputune&gt;
    &lt;vcpupin vcpu="0" cpuset="1-4,^2"/&gt;
    &lt;vcpupin vcpu="1" cpuset="0,1"/&gt;
    &lt;vcpupin vcpu="2" cpuset="2,3"/&gt;
    &lt;vcpupin vcpu="3" cpuset="0,4"/&gt;
J
Jiri Denemark 已提交
603
    &lt;emulatorpin cpuset="1-3"/&gt;
604 605
    &lt;iothreadpin iothread="1" cpuset="5,6"/&gt;
    &lt;iothreadpin iothread="2" cpuset="7,8"/&gt;
606 607 608
    &lt;shares&gt;2048&lt;/shares&gt;
    &lt;period&gt;1000000&lt;/period&gt;
    &lt;quota&gt;-1&lt;/quota&gt;
609 610
    &lt;emulator_period&gt;1000000&lt;/emulator_period&gt;
    &lt;emulator_quota&gt;-1&lt;/emulator_quota&gt;
611 612
    &lt;vcpusched vcpus='0-4,^3' scheduler='fifo' priority='1'/&gt;
    &lt;iothreadsched iothreads='2' scheduler='batch'/&gt;
613 614 615 616 617 618
  &lt;/cputune&gt;
  ...
&lt;/domain&gt;
</pre>

    <dl>
619
      <dt><code>cputune</code></dt>
620 621 622 623 624
      <dd>
         The optional <code>cputune</code> element provides details
         regarding the cpu tunable parameters for the domain.
         <span class="since">Since 0.9.0</span>
      </dd>
625
      <dt><code>vcpupin</code></dt>
626
      <dd>
627
        The optional <code>vcpupin</code> element specifies which of host's
628 629 630 631 632 633 634
        physical CPUs the domain VCPU will be pinned to. If this is omitted,
        and attribute <code>cpuset</code> of element <code>vcpu</code> is
        not specified, the vCPU is pinned to all the physical CPUs by default.
        It contains two required attributes, the attribute <code>vcpu</code>
        specifies vcpu id, and the attribute <code>cpuset</code> is same as
        attribute <code>cpuset</code> of element <code>vcpu</code>.
        (NB: Only qemu driver support)
635 636
        <span class="since">Since 0.9.0</span>
       </dd>
T
Tang Chen 已提交
637 638 639
       <dt><code>emulatorpin</code></dt>
       <dd>
         The optional <code>emulatorpin</code> element specifies which of host
640 641
         physical CPUs the "emulator", a subset of a domain not including vcpu
         or iothreads will be pinned to. If this is omitted, and attribute
642 643 644
         <code>cpuset</code> of element <code>vcpu</code> is not specified,
         "emulator" is pinned to all the physical CPUs by default. It contains
         one required attribute <code>cpuset</code> specifying which physical
645
         CPUs to pin to.
T
Tang Chen 已提交
646
       </dd>
647 648 649 650 651 652 653
       <dt><code>iothreadpin</code></dt>
       <dd>
         The optional <code>iothreadpin</code> element specifies which of host
         physical CPUs the IOThreads will be pinned to. If this is omitted
         and attribute <code>cpuset</code> of element <code>vcpu</code> is
         not specified, the IOThreads are pinned to all the physical CPUs
         by default. There are two required attributes, the attribute
654 655 656 657 658
         <code>iothread</code> specifies the IOThread ID and the attribute
         <code>cpuset</code> specifying which physical CPUs to pin to. See
         the <code>iothreadids</code>
         <a href="#elementsIOThreadsAllocation"><code>description</code></a>
         for valid <code>iothread</code> values.
659 660
        <span class="since">Since 1.2.9</span>
       </dd>
661
      <dt><code>shares</code></dt>
662 663
      <dd>
        The optional <code>shares</code> element specifies the proportional
664
        weighted share for the domain. If this is omitted, it defaults to
E
Eric Blake 已提交
665 666 667
        the OS provided defaults. NB, There is no unit for the value,
        it's a relative measure based on the setting of other VM,
        e.g. A VM configured with value
668 669 670
        2048 will get twice as much CPU time as a VM configured with value 1024.
        <span class="since">Since 0.9.0</span>
      </dd>
671 672 673 674 675 676
      <dt><code>period</code></dt>
      <dd>
        The optional <code>period</code> element specifies the enforcement
        interval(unit: microseconds). Within <code>period</code>, each vcpu of
        the domain will not be allowed to consume more than <code>quota</code>
        worth of runtime. The value should be in range [1000, 1000000]. A period
677 678 679
        with value 0 means no value.
        <span class="since">Only QEMU driver support since 0.9.4, LXC since
        0.9.10</span>
680 681 682 683 684 685 686 687 688
      </dd>
      <dt><code>quota</code></dt>
      <dd>
        The optional <code>quota</code> element specifies the maximum allowed
        bandwidth(unit: microseconds). A domain with <code>quota</code> as any
        negative value indicates that the domain has infinite bandwidth, which
        means that it is not bandwidth controlled. The value should be in range
        [1000, 18446744073709551] or less than 0. A quota with value 0 means no
        value. You can use this feature to ensure that all vcpus run at the same
689 690 691
        speed.
        <span class="since">Only QEMU driver support since 0.9.4, LXC since
        0.9.10</span>
692
      </dd>
693 694 695 696 697 698 699 700 701 702 703 704 705 706 707 708 709 710 711 712 713 714

      <dt><code>emulator_period</code></dt>
      <dd>
        The optional <code>emulator_period</code> element specifies the enforcement
        interval(unit: microseconds). Within <code>emulator_period</code>, emulator
        threads(those excluding vcpus) of the domain will not be allowed to consume
        more than <code>emulator_quota</code> worth of runtime. The value should be
        in range [1000, 1000000]. A period with value 0 means no value.
        <span class="since">Only QEMU driver support since 0.10.0</span>
      </dd>
      <dt><code>emulator_quota</code></dt>
      <dd>
        The optional <code>emulator_quota</code> element specifies the maximum
        allowed bandwidth(unit: microseconds) for domain's emulator threads(those
        excluding vcpus). A domain with <code>emulator_quota</code> as any negative
        value indicates that the domain has infinite bandwidth for emulator threads
        (those excluding vcpus), which means that it is not bandwidth controlled.
        The value should be in range [1000, 18446744073709551] or less than 0. A
        quota with value 0 means no value.
        <span class="since">Only QEMU driver support since 0.10.0</span>
      </dd>

715 716 717 718 719 720
      <dt><code>vcpusched</code> and <code>iothreadsched</code></dt>
      <dd>
        The optional <code>vcpusched</code> elements specifies the scheduler
        type (values <code>batch</code>, <code>idle</code>, <code>fifo</code>,
        <code>rr</code>) for particular vCPU/IOThread threads (based on
        <code>vcpus</code> and <code>iothreads</code>, leaving out
721 722 723 724 725 726 727 728
        <code>vcpus</code>/<code>iothreads</code> sets the default). Valid
        <code>vcpus</code> values start at 0 through one less than the
        number of vCPU's defined for the domain. Valid <code>iothreads</code>
        values are described in the <code>iothreadids</code>
        <a href="#elementsIOThreadsAllocation"><code>description</code></a>.
        If no <code>iothreadids</code> are defined, then libvirt numbers
        IOThreads from 1 to the number of <code>iothreads</code> available
        for the domain. For real-time schedulers (<code>fifo</code>,
729
        <code>rr</code>), priority must be specified as
730 731
        well (and is ignored for non-real-time ones). The value range
        for the priority depends on the host kernel (usually 1-99).
732
        <span class="since">Since 1.2.13</span>
733 734
      </dd>

735 736 737 738 739 740 741 742
    </dl>


    <h3><a name="elementsMemoryAllocation">Memory Allocation</a></h3>

<pre>
&lt;domain&gt;
  ...
743
  &lt;maxMemory slots='16' unit='KiB'&gt;1524288&lt;/maxMemory&gt;
E
Eric Blake 已提交
744 745
  &lt;memory unit='KiB'&gt;524288&lt;/memory&gt;
  &lt;currentMemory unit='KiB'&gt;524288&lt;/currentMemory&gt;
746 747 748 749 750 751
  ...
&lt;/domain&gt;
</pre>

    <dl>
      <dt><code>memory</code></dt>
752 753 754
      <dd>The maximum allocation of memory for the guest at boot time. The
        memory allocation includes possible additional memory devices specified
        at start or hotplugged later.
E
Eric Blake 已提交
755
        The units for this value are determined by the optional
756
        attribute <code>unit</code>, which defaults to "KiB"
E
Eric Blake 已提交
757 758 759 760 761 762 763 764 765 766 767 768 769
        (kibibytes, 2<sup>10</sup> or blocks of 1024 bytes).  Valid
        units are "b" or "bytes" for bytes, "KB" for kilobytes
        (10<sup>3</sup> or 1,000 bytes), "k" or "KiB" for kibibytes
        (1024 bytes), "MB" for megabytes (10<sup>6</sup> or 1,000,000
        bytes), "M" or "MiB" for mebibytes (2<sup>20</sup> or
        1,048,576 bytes), "GB" for gigabytes (10<sup>9</sup> or
        1,000,000,000 bytes), "G" or "GiB" for gibibytes
        (2<sup>30</sup> or 1,073,741,824 bytes), "TB" for terabytes
        (10<sup>12</sup> or 1,000,000,000,000 bytes), or "T" or "TiB"
        for tebibytes (2<sup>40</sup> or 1,099,511,627,776 bytes).
        However, the value will be rounded up to the nearest kibibyte
        by libvirt, and may be further rounded to the granularity
        supported by the hypervisor.  Some hypervisors also enforce a
770 771
        minimum, such as 4000KiB.

772 773 774
        In case <a href="#elementsCPU">NUMA</a> is configured for the guest the
        <code>memory</code> element can be omitted.

775 776 777 778 779 780 781
        In the case of crash, optional attribute <code>dumpCore</code>
        can be used to control whether the guest memory should be
        included in the generated coredump or not (values "on", "off").

        <span class='since'><code>unit</code> since 0.9.11</span>,
        <span class='since'><code>dumpCore</code> since 0.10.2
        (QEMU only)</span></dd>
782 783 784 785 786 787 788 789 790 791 792 793 794 795 796 797
      <dt><code>maxMemory</code></dt>
      <dd>The run time maximum memory allocation of the guest. The initial
        memory specified by either the <code>&lt;memory&gt;</code> element or
        the NUMA cell size configuration can be increased by hot-plugging of
        memory to the limit specified by this element.

        The <code>unit</code> attribute behaves the same as for
        <code>&lt;memory&gt;</code>.

        The <code>slots</code> attribute specifies the number of slots
        available for adding memory to the guest. The bounds are hypervisor
        specific.

        Note that due to alignment of the memory chunks added via memory
        hotplug the full size allocation specified by this element may be
        impossible to achieve.
798
        <span class='since'>Since 1.2.14 supported by the QEMU driver.</span>
799 800
      </dd>

801 802 803 804
      <dt><code>currentMemory</code></dt>
      <dd>The actual allocation of memory for the guest. This value can
        be less than the maximum allocation, to allow for ballooning
        up the guests memory on the fly. If this is omitted, it defaults
E
Eric Blake 已提交
805 806 807
        to the same value as the <code>memory</code> element.
        The <code>unit</code> attribute behaves the same as
        for <code>memory</code>.</dd>
808 809 810 811 812 813 814 815 816
    </dl>


    <h3><a name="elementsMemoryBacking">Memory Backing</a></h3>

<pre>
&lt;domain&gt;
  ...
  &lt;memoryBacking&gt;
817 818 819
    &lt;hugepages&gt;
      &lt;page size="1" unit="G" nodeset="0-3,5"/&gt;
      &lt;page size="2" unit="M" nodeset="4"/&gt;
820
    &lt;/hugepages&gt;
821
    &lt;nosharepages/&gt;
822
    &lt;locked/&gt;
823 824 825 826 827
  &lt;/memoryBacking&gt;
  ...
&lt;/domain&gt;
</pre>

828 829 830 831
    <p>The optional <code>memoryBacking</code> element may contain several
      elements that influence how virtual memory pages are backed by host
      pages.</p>

832
    <dl>
833 834
      <dt><code>hugepages</code></dt>
      <dd>This tells the hypervisor that the guest should have its memory
835 836 837 838 839 840 841 842 843 844 845 846 847
      allocated using hugepages instead of the normal native page size.
      <span class='since'>Since 1.2.5</span> it's possible to set hugepages
      more specifically per numa node. The <code>page</code> element is
      introduced. It has one compulsory attribute <code>size</code> which
      specifies which hugepages should be used (especially useful on systems
      supporting hugepages of different sizes). The default unit for the
      <code>size</code> attribute is kilobytes (multiplier of 1024). If you
      want to use different unit, use optional <code>unit</code> attribute.
      For systems with NUMA, the optional <code>nodeset</code> attribute may
      come handy as it ties given guest's NUMA nodes to certain hugepage
      sizes. From the example snippet, one gigabyte hugepages are used for
      every NUMA node except node number four. For the correct syntax see
      <a href="#elementsNUMATuning">this</a>.</dd>
848 849 850 851 852 853
      <dt><code>nosharepages</code></dt>
      <dd>Instructs hypervisor to disable shared pages (memory merge, KSM) for
        this domain. <span class="since">Since 1.0.6</span></dd>
      <dt><code>locked</code></dt>
      <dd>When set and supported by the hypervisor, memory pages belonging
        to the domain will be locked in host's memory and the host will not
854
        be allowed to swap them out. For QEMU/KVM this requires
E
Eric Blake 已提交
855
        <code>hard_limit</code> <a href="#elementsMemoryTuning">memory tuning</a>
856 857
        element to be used and set to the maximum memory configured for the
        domain plus any memory consumed by the QEMU process itself.
858
        <span class="since">Since 1.0.6</span></dd>
859 860 861 862 863 864 865 866 867
    </dl>


    <h3><a name="elementsMemoryTuning">Memory Tuning</a></h3>

<pre>
&lt;domain&gt;
  ...
  &lt;memtune&gt;
E
Eric Blake 已提交
868 869 870 871
    &lt;hard_limit unit='G'&gt;1&lt;/hard_limit&gt;
    &lt;soft_limit unit='M'&gt;128&lt;/soft_limit&gt;
    &lt;swap_hard_limit unit='G'&gt;2&lt;/swap_hard_limit&gt;
    &lt;min_guarantee unit='bytes'&gt;67108864&lt;/min_guarantee&gt;
872 873 874 875 876 877 878 879 880 881 882 883 884
  &lt;/memtune&gt;
  ...
&lt;/domain&gt;
</pre>

    <dl>
      <dt><code>memtune</code></dt>
      <dd> The optional <code>memtune</code> element provides details
        regarding the memory tunable parameters for the domain. If this is
        omitted, it defaults to the OS provided defaults. For QEMU/KVM, the
        parameters are applied to the QEMU process as a whole. Thus, when
        counting them, one needs to add up guest RAM, guest video RAM, and
        some memory overhead of QEMU itself. The last piece is hard to
E
Eric Blake 已提交
885 886 887 888 889 890
        determine so one needs guess and try.  For each tunable, it
        is possible to designate which unit the number is in on
        input, using the same values as
        for <code>&lt;memory&gt;</code>.  For backwards
        compatibility, output is always in
        KiB.  <span class='since'><code>unit</code>
891 892 893
        since 0.9.11</span>
        Possible values for all *_limit parameters are in range from 0 to
        VIR_DOMAIN_MEMORY_PARAM_UNLIMITED.</dd>
894 895
      <dt><code>hard_limit</code></dt>
      <dd> The optional <code>hard_limit</code> element is the maximum memory
896
        the guest can use. The units for this value are kibibytes (i.e. blocks
897
        of 1024 bytes). <strong>However, users of QEMU and KVM are strongly
M
Michal Privoznik 已提交
898 899 900
        advised not to set this limit as domain may get killed by the kernel
        if the guess is too low. To determine the memory needed for a process
        to run is an
901 902
        <a href="http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Undecidable_problem">
        undecidable problem</a>.</strong></dd>
903 904 905
      <dt><code>soft_limit</code></dt>
      <dd> The optional <code>soft_limit</code> element is the memory limit to
        enforce during memory contention. The units for this value are
906
        kibibytes (i.e. blocks of 1024 bytes)</dd>
907 908 909
      <dt><code>swap_hard_limit</code></dt>
      <dd> The optional <code>swap_hard_limit</code> element is the maximum
        memory plus swap the guest can use. The units for this value are
910
        kibibytes (i.e. blocks of 1024 bytes). This has to be more than
911 912 913 914
        hard_limit value provided</dd>
      <dt><code>min_guarantee</code></dt>
      <dd> The optional <code>min_guarantee</code> element is the guaranteed
        minimum memory allocation for the guest. The units for this value are
915 916
        kibibytes (i.e. blocks of 1024 bytes). This element is only supported
        by VMware ESX and OpenVZ drivers.</dd>
917 918 919 920 921 922 923 924 925 926
    </dl>


    <h3><a name="elementsNUMATuning">NUMA Node Tuning</a></h3>

<pre>
&lt;domain&gt;
  ...
  &lt;numatune&gt;
    &lt;memory mode="strict" nodeset="1-4,^3"/&gt;
927 928
    &lt;memnode cellid="0" mode="strict" nodeset="1"/&gt;
    &lt;memnode cellid="2" mode="preferred" nodeset="2"/&gt;
929 930 931 932 933 934
  &lt;/numatune&gt;
  ...
&lt;/domain&gt;
</pre>

    <dl>
935 936 937 938 939 940
      <dt><code>numatune</code></dt>
      <dd>
        The optional <code>numatune</code> element provides details of
        how to tune the performance of a NUMA host via controlling NUMA policy
        for domain process. NB, only supported by QEMU driver.
        <span class='since'>Since 0.9.3</span>
941
      </dd>
942 943
      <dt><code>memory</code></dt>
      <dd>
O
Osier Yang 已提交
944
        The optional <code>memory</code> element specifies how to allocate memory
945 946 947 948 949 950 951 952 953 954 955 956 957 958 959 960 961 962
        for the domain process on a NUMA host. It contains several optional
        attributes. Attribute <code>mode</code> is either 'interleave',
        'strict', or 'preferred', defaults to 'strict'. Attribute
        <code>nodeset</code> specifies the NUMA nodes, using the same syntax as
        attribute <code>cpuset</code> of element <code>vcpu</code>. Attribute
        <code>placement</code> (<span class='since'>since 0.9.12</span>) can be
        used to indicate the memory placement mode for domain process, its value
        can be either "static" or "auto", defaults to <code>placement</code> of
        <code>vcpu</code>, or "static" if <code>nodeset</code> is specified.
        "auto" indicates the domain process will only allocate memory from the
        advisory nodeset returned from querying numad, and the value of attribute
        <code>nodeset</code> will be ignored if it's specified.

        If <code>placement</code> of <code>vcpu</code> is 'auto', and
        <code>numatune</code> is not specified, a default <code>numatune</code>
        with <code>placement</code> 'auto' and <code>mode</code> 'strict' will
        be added implicitly.

963 964
        <span class='since'>Since 0.9.3</span>
      </dd>
965 966 967 968 969 970 971 972 973 974 975 976 977
      <dt><code>memnode</code></dt>
      <dd>
        Optional <code>memnode</code> elements can specify memory allocation
        policies per each guest NUMA node.  For those nodes having no
        corresponding <code>memnode</code> element, the default from
        element <code>memory</code> will be used.  Attribute <code>cellid</code>
        addresses guest NUMA node for which the settings are applied.
        Attributes <code>mode</code> and <code>nodeset</code> have the same
        meaning and syntax as in <code>memory</code> element.

        This setting is not compatible with automatic placement.
        <span class='since'>QEMU Since 1.2.7</span>
      </dd>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
978 979
    </dl>

980 981 982 983 984 985 986

    <h3><a name="elementsBlockTuning">Block I/O Tuning</a></h3>
<pre>
&lt;domain&gt;
  ...
  &lt;blkiotune&gt;
    &lt;weight&gt;800&lt;/weight&gt;
987 988 989 990 991 992 993 994
    &lt;device&gt;
      &lt;path&gt;/dev/sda&lt;/path&gt;
      &lt;weight&gt;1000&lt;/weight&gt;
    &lt;/device&gt;
    &lt;device&gt;
      &lt;path&gt;/dev/sdb&lt;/path&gt;
      &lt;weight&gt;500&lt;/weight&gt;
    &lt;/device&gt;
995 996 997 998 999 1000 1001 1002 1003
  &lt;/blkiotune&gt;
  ...
&lt;/domain&gt;
</pre>

    <dl>
      <dt><code>blkiotune</code></dt>
      <dd> The optional <code>blkiotune</code> element provides the ability
        to tune Blkio cgroup tunable parameters for the domain. If this is
1004 1005
        omitted, it defaults to the OS provided
        defaults. <span class="since">Since 0.8.8</span></dd>
1006
      <dt><code>weight</code></dt>
1007 1008
      <dd> The optional <code>weight</code> element is the overall I/O
        weight of the guest. The value should be in the range [100,
1009 1010
        1000]. After kernel 2.6.39, the value could be in the
        range [10, 1000].</dd>
1011 1012 1013 1014 1015 1016 1017 1018
      <dt><code>device</code></dt>
      <dd>The domain may have multiple <code>device</code> elements
        that further tune the weights for each host block device in
        use by the domain.  Note that
        multiple <a href="#elementsDisks">guest disks</a> can share a
        single host block device, if they are backed by files within
        the same host file system, which is why this tuning parameter
        is at the global domain level rather than associated with each
L
Lei Li 已提交
1019 1020 1021 1022 1023
        guest disk device (contrast this to
        the <a href="#elementsDisks"><code>&lt;iotune&gt;</code></a>
        element which can apply to an
        individual <code>&lt;disk&gt;</code>).
        Each <code>device</code> element has two
1024 1025 1026
        mandatory sub-elements, <code>path</code> describing the
        absolute path of the device, and <code>weight</code> giving
        the relative weight of that device, in the range [100,
1027 1028
        1000]. After kernel 2.6.39, the value could be in the
        range [10, 1000].<span class="since">Since 0.9.8</span></dd>
1029 1030 1031
    </dl>


1032 1033 1034 1035 1036 1037 1038
    <h3><a name="resPartition">Resource partitioning</a></h3>

    <p>
      Hypervisors may allow for virtual machines to be placed into
      resource partitions, potentially with nesting of said partitions.
      The <code>resource</code> element groups together configuration
      related to resource partitioning. It currently supports a child
1039
      element <code>partition</code> whose content defines the absolute path
1040 1041 1042 1043 1044 1045 1046 1047 1048 1049 1050 1051 1052 1053 1054 1055 1056
      of the resource partition in which to place the domain. If no
      partition is listed, then the domain will be placed in a default
      partition. It is the responsibility of the app/admin to ensure
      that the partition exists prior to starting the guest. Only the
      (hypervisor specific) default partition can be assumed to exist
      by default.
    </p>
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;resource&gt;
    &lt;partition&gt;/virtualmachines/production&lt;/partition&gt;
  &lt;/resource&gt;
  ...
</pre>

    <p>
      Resource partitions are currently supported by the QEMU and
E
Eric Blake 已提交
1057
      LXC drivers, which map partition paths to cgroups directories,
1058 1059 1060
      in all mounted controllers. <span class="since">Since 1.0.5</span>
    </p>

1061 1062 1063 1064 1065 1066 1067 1068
    <h3><a name="elementsCPU">CPU model and topology</a></h3>

    <p>
      Requirements for CPU model, its features and topology can be specified
      using the following collection of elements.
      <span class="since">Since 0.7.5</span>
    </p>

1069 1070 1071
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;cpu match='exact'&gt;
1072
    &lt;model fallback='allow'&gt;core2duo&lt;/model&gt;
J
Jiri Denemark 已提交
1073
    &lt;vendor&gt;Intel&lt;/vendor&gt;
1074 1075 1076 1077
    &lt;topology sockets='1' cores='2' threads='1'/&gt;
    &lt;feature policy='disable' name='lahf_lm'/&gt;
  &lt;/cpu&gt;
  ...</pre>
1078

1079 1080 1081 1082 1083 1084 1085 1086
<pre>
  &lt;cpu mode='host-model'&gt;
    &lt;model fallback='forbid'/&gt;
    &lt;topology sockets='1' cores='2' threads='1'/&gt;
  &lt;/cpu&gt;
  ...</pre>

<pre>
1087
  &lt;cpu mode='host-passthrough'&gt;
1088
    &lt;feature policy='disable' name='lahf_lm'/&gt;
1089 1090
  ...</pre>

1091 1092 1093 1094 1095 1096
    <p>
      In case no restrictions need to be put on CPU model and its features, a
      simpler <code>cpu</code> element can be used.
      <span class="since">Since 0.7.6</span>
    </p>

1097 1098 1099 1100 1101 1102
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;cpu&gt;
    &lt;topology sockets='1' cores='2' threads='1'/&gt;
  &lt;/cpu&gt;
  ...</pre>
1103 1104 1105 1106 1107 1108 1109 1110 1111 1112 1113 1114 1115 1116 1117 1118 1119 1120 1121 1122 1123 1124

    <dl>
      <dt><code>cpu</code></dt>
      <dd>The <code>cpu</code> element is the main container for describing
        guest CPU requirements. Its <code>match</code> attribute specified how
        strictly has the virtual CPU provided to the guest match these
        requirements. <span class="since">Since 0.7.6</span> the
        <code>match</code> attribute can be omitted if <code>topology</code>
        is the only element within <code>cpu</code>. Possible values for the
        <code>match</code> attribute are:

        <dl>
          <dt><code>minimum</code></dt>
          <dd>The specified CPU model and features describes the minimum
            requested CPU.</dd>
          <dt><code>exact</code></dt>
          <dd>The virtual CPU provided to the guest will exactly match the
            specification</dd>
          <dt><code>strict</code></dt>
          <dd>The guest will not be created unless the host CPU does exactly
            match the specification.</dd>
        </dl>
1125

E
Eric Blake 已提交
1126 1127
        <span class="since">Since 0.8.5</span> the <code>match</code>
        attribute can be omitted and will default to <code>exact</code>.
1128 1129 1130 1131 1132 1133 1134 1135 1136 1137 1138 1139 1140 1141 1142 1143 1144 1145

        <span class="since">Since 0.9.10</span>, an optional <code>mode</code>
        attribute may be used to make it easier to configure a guest CPU to be
        as close to host CPU as possible. Possible values for the
        <code>mode</code> attribute are:

        <dl>
          <dt><code>custom</code></dt>
          <dd>In this mode, the <code>cpu</code> element describes the CPU
          that should be presented to the guest. This is the default when no
          <code>mode</code> attribute is specified. This mode makes it so that
          a persistent guest will see the same hardware no matter what host
          the guest is booted on.</dd>
          <dt><code>host-model</code></dt>
          <dd>The <code>host-model</code> mode is essentially a shortcut to
          copying host CPU definition from capabilities XML into domain XML.
          Since the CPU definition is copied just before starting a domain,
          exactly the same XML can be used on different hosts while still
1146 1147 1148 1149 1150 1151 1152 1153 1154
          providing the best guest CPU each host supports. The
          <code>match</code> attribute can't be used in this mode. Specifying
          CPU model is not supported either, but <code>model</code>'s
          <code>fallback</code> attribute may still be used. Using the
          <code>feature</code> element, specific flags may be enabled or
          disabled specifically in addition to the host model. This may be
          used to fine tune features that can be emulated.
          <span class="since">(Since 1.1.1)</span>.
          Libvirt does not model every aspect of each CPU so
1155 1156 1157 1158 1159 1160 1161
          the guest CPU will not match the host CPU exactly. On the other
          hand, the ABI provided to the guest is reproducible. During
          migration, complete CPU model definition is transferred to the
          destination host so the migrated guest will see exactly the same CPU
          model even if the destination host contains more capable CPUs for
          the running instance of the guest; but shutting down and restarting
          the guest may present different hardware to the guest according to
1162 1163 1164 1165 1166 1167 1168 1169 1170
          the capabilities of the new host. <strong>Beware</strong>, due to the
          way libvirt detects host CPU and due to the fact libvirt does not
          talk to QEMU/KVM when creating the CPU model, CPU configuration
          created using <code>host-model</code> may not work as expected. The
          guest CPU may differ from the configuration and it may also confuse
          guest OS by using a combination of CPU features and other parameters
          (such as CPUID level) that don't work. Until these issues are fixed,
          it's a good idea to avoid using <code>host-model</code> and use
          <code>custom</code> mode with just the CPU model from host
1171 1172 1173 1174 1175 1176 1177 1178 1179 1180 1181 1182 1183 1184
          capabilities XML.
          <span class="since">(Since 1.2.11)</span>. PowerISA allows
          processors to run VMs in binary compatibility mode supporting an
          older version of ISA.  Libvirt on PowerPC architecture uses the
          <code>host-model</code> to signify a guest mode CPU running in
          binary compatibility mode. Example:
          When a user needs a power7 VM to run in compatibility mode
          on a Power8 host, this can be described in XML as follows :
<pre>
  &lt;cpu mode='host-model'&gt;
    &lt;model&gt;power7&lt;/model&gt;
  &lt;/cpu&gt;
  ...</pre>
          </dd>
1185 1186 1187 1188 1189
          <dt><code>host-passthrough</code></dt>
          <dd>With this mode, the CPU visible to the guest should be exactly
          the same as the host CPU even in the aspects that libvirt does not
          understand. Though the downside of this mode is that the guest
          environment cannot be reproduced on different hardware. Thus, if you
1190 1191
          hit any bugs, you are on your own. Further details of that CPU can
          be changed using <code>feature</code> elements.</dd>
1192 1193 1194 1195 1196 1197 1198 1199 1200 1201 1202
        </dl>

        In both <code>host-model</code> and <code>host-passthrough</code>
        mode, the real (approximate in <code>host-passthrough</code> mode) CPU
        definition which would be used on current host can be determined by
        specifying <code>VIR_DOMAIN_XML_UPDATE_CPU</code> flag when calling
        <code>virDomainGetXMLDesc</code> API. When running a guest that might
        be prone to operating system reactivation when presented with
        different hardware, and which will be migrated between hosts with
        different capabilities, you can use this output to rewrite XML to the
        <code>custom</code> mode for more robust migration.
1203 1204 1205 1206 1207 1208
      </dd>

      <dt><code>model</code></dt>
      <dd>The content of the <code>model</code> element specifies CPU model
        requested by the guest. The list of available CPU models and their
        definition can be found in <code>cpu_map.xml</code> file installed
1209 1210 1211 1212 1213 1214 1215 1216
        in libvirt's data directory. If a hypervisor is not able to use the
        exact CPU model, libvirt automatically falls back to a closest model
        supported by the hypervisor while maintaining the list of CPU
        features. <span class="since">Since 0.9.10</span>, an optional
        <code>fallback</code> attribute can be used to forbid this behavior,
        in which case an attempt to start a domain requesting an unsupported
        CPU model will fail. Supported values for <code>fallback</code>
        attribute are: <code>allow</code> (this is the default), and
1217
        <code>forbid</code>. The optional <code>vendor_id</code> attribute
1218
        (<span class="since">Since 0.10.0</span>)  can be used to set the
1219 1220 1221
        vendor id seen by the guest. It must be exactly 12 characters long.
        If not set the vendor id of the host is used. Typical possible
        values are "AuthenticAMD" and "GenuineIntel".</dd>
1222

J
Jiri Denemark 已提交
1223 1224 1225 1226 1227 1228 1229
      <dt><code>vendor</code></dt>
      <dd><span class="since">Since 0.8.3</span> the content of the
        <code>vendor</code> element specifies CPU vendor requested by the
        guest. If this element is missing, the guest can be run on a CPU
        matching given features regardless on its vendor. The list of
        supported vendors can be found in <code>cpu_map.xml</code>.</dd>

1230 1231 1232 1233 1234 1235 1236 1237 1238 1239 1240 1241 1242 1243 1244 1245 1246 1247 1248 1249 1250 1251 1252 1253 1254 1255 1256 1257 1258 1259 1260
      <dt><code>topology</code></dt>
      <dd>The <code>topology</code> element specifies requested topology of
        virtual CPU provided to the guest. Three non-zero values have to be
        given for <code>sockets</code>, <code>cores</code>, and
        <code>threads</code>: total number of CPU sockets, number of cores per
        socket, and number of threads per core, respectively.</dd>

      <dt><code>feature</code></dt>
      <dd>The <code>cpu</code> element can contain zero or more
        <code>elements</code> used to fine-tune features provided by the
        selected CPU model. The list of known feature names can be found in
        the same file as CPU models. The meaning of each <code>feature</code>
        element depends on its <code>policy</code> attribute, which has to be
        set to one of the following values:

        <dl>
          <dt><code>force</code></dt>
          <dd>The virtual CPU will claim the feature is supported regardless
            of it being supported by host CPU.</dd>
          <dt><code>require</code></dt>
          <dd>Guest creation will fail unless the feature is supported by host
            CPU.</dd>
          <dt><code>optional</code></dt>
          <dd>The feature will be supported by virtual CPU if and only if it
            is supported by host CPU.</dd>
          <dt><code>disable</code></dt>
          <dd>The feature will not be supported by virtual CPU.</dd>
          <dt><code>forbid</code></dt>
          <dd>Guest creation will fail if the feature is supported by host
            CPU.</dd>
        </dl>
1261

E
Eric Blake 已提交
1262 1263
        <span class="since">Since 0.8.5</span> the <code>policy</code>
        attribute can be omitted and will default to <code>require</code>.
1264 1265 1266
      </dd>
    </dl>

1267
    <p>
1268
      Guest NUMA topology can be specified using the <code>numa</code> element.
1269 1270 1271 1272 1273 1274 1275 1276
      <span class="since">Since 0.9.8</span>
    </p>

<pre>
  ...
  &lt;cpu&gt;
    ...
    &lt;numa&gt;
1277 1278
      &lt;cell id='0' cpus='0-3' memory='512000' unit='KiB'/&gt;
      &lt;cell id='1' cpus='4-7' memory='512000' unit='KiB' memAccess='shared'/&gt;
1279 1280 1281 1282 1283 1284 1285
    &lt;/numa&gt;
    ...
  &lt;/cpu&gt;
  ...</pre>

    <p>
      Each <code>cell</code> element specifies a NUMA cell or a NUMA node.
1286 1287 1288
      <code>cpus</code> specifies the CPU or range of CPUs that are
      part of the node. <code>memory</code> specifies the node memory
      in kibibytes (i.e. blocks of 1024 bytes).
1289 1290 1291
      <span class="since">Since 1.2.11</span> one can use an additional <a
          href="#elementsMemoryAllocation"><code>unit</code></a> attribute to
      define units in which <code>memory</code> is specified.
1292 1293 1294 1295 1296 1297
      <span class="since">Since 1.2.7</span> all cells should
      have <code>id</code> attribute in case referring to some cell is
      necessary in the code, otherwise the cells are
      assigned <code>id</code>s in the increasing order starting from
      0.  Mixing cells with and without the <code>id</code> attribute
      is not recommended as it may result in unwanted behaviour.
1298 1299 1300 1301 1302

      <span class='since'>Since 1.2.9</span> the optional attribute
      <code>memAccess</code> can control whether the memory is to be
      mapped as "shared" or "private".  This is valid only for
      hugepages-backed memory.
1303 1304 1305 1306 1307 1308
    </p>

    <p>
      This guest NUMA specification is currently available only for QEMU/KVM.
    </p>

1309
    <h3><a name="elementsEvents">Events configuration</a></h3>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
1310 1311

    <p>
A
Atsushi SAKAI 已提交
1312
      It is sometimes necessary to override the default actions taken
1313 1314
      on various events. Not all hypervisors support all events and actions.
      The actions may be taken as a result of calls to libvirt APIs
1315 1316 1317 1318 1319 1320 1321 1322 1323 1324
      <a href="html/libvirt-libvirt-domain.html#virDomainReboot">
        <code>virDomainReboot</code>
      </a>,
      <a href="html/libvirt-libvirt-domain.html#virDomainShutdown">
        <code>virDomainShutdown</code>
      </a>,
      or
      <a href="html/libvirt-libvirt-domain.html#virDomainShutdownFlags">
        <code>virDomainShutdownFlags</code>
      </a>.
1325 1326
      Using <code>virsh reboot</code> or <code>virsh shutdown</code> would
      also trigger the event.
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
1327 1328
    </p>

1329 1330 1331 1332 1333
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;on_poweroff&gt;destroy&lt;/on_poweroff&gt;
  &lt;on_reboot&gt;restart&lt;/on_reboot&gt;
  &lt;on_crash&gt;restart&lt;/on_crash&gt;
1334
  &lt;on_lockfailure&gt;poweroff&lt;/on_lockfailure&gt;
1335
  ...</pre>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
1336

1337 1338 1339 1340 1341 1342 1343
    <p>
      The following collections of elements allow the actions to be
      specified when a guest OS triggers a lifecycle operation. A
      common use case is to force a reboot to be treated as a poweroff
      when doing the initial OS installation. This allows the VM to be
      re-configured for the first post-install bootup.
    </p>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
1344 1345 1346
    <dl>
      <dt><code>on_poweroff</code></dt>
      <dd>The content of this element specifies the action to take when
M
Matthew Booth 已提交
1347
        the guest requests a poweroff.</dd>
D
Daniel Veillard 已提交
1348
      <dt><code>on_reboot</code></dt>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
1349
      <dd>The content of this element specifies the action to take when
M
Matthew Booth 已提交
1350
        the guest requests a reboot.</dd>
D
Daniel Veillard 已提交
1351
      <dt><code>on_crash</code></dt>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
1352
      <dd>The content of this element specifies the action to take when
M
Matthew Booth 已提交
1353
        the guest crashes.</dd>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
1354 1355 1356 1357 1358 1359 1360 1361 1362
    </dl>

    <p>
      Each of these states allow for the same four possible actions.
    </p>

    <dl>
      <dt><code>destroy</code></dt>
      <dd>The domain will be terminated completely and all resources
1363
        released.</dd>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
1364
      <dt><code>restart</code></dt>
1365 1366
      <dd>The domain will be terminated and then restarted with
        the same configuration.</dd>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
1367
      <dt><code>preserve</code></dt>
1368
      <dd>The domain will be terminated and its resource preserved
M
Matthew Booth 已提交
1369
        to allow analysis.</dd>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
1370
      <dt><code>rename-restart</code></dt>
1371 1372
      <dd>The domain will be terminated and then restarted with
        a new name.</dd>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
1373 1374
    </dl>

1375
    <p>
1376 1377 1378 1379 1380 1381 1382 1383 1384 1385
    QEMU/KVM supports the <code>on_poweroff</code> and <code>on_reboot</code>
    events handling the <code>destroy</code> and <code>restart</code> actions.
    The <code>preserve</code> action for an <code>on_reboot</code> event
    is treated as a <code>destroy</code> and the <code>rename-restart</code>
    action for an <code>on_poweroff</code> event is treated as a
    <code>restart</code> event.
    </p>

    <p>
      The <code>on_crash</code> event supports these additional
1386 1387 1388 1389 1390 1391 1392 1393 1394 1395 1396 1397 1398
      actions <span class="since">since 0.8.4</span>.
    </p>

    <dl>
      <dt><code>coredump-destroy</code></dt>
      <dd>The crashed domain's core will be dumped, and then the
        domain will be terminated completely and all resources
        released</dd>
      <dt><code>coredump-restart</code></dt>
      <dd>The crashed domain's core will be dumped, and then the
        domain will be restarted with the same configuration</dd>
    </dl>

1399 1400
    <p>
      The <code>on_lockfailure</code> element (<span class="since">since
1401
      1.0.0</span>) may be used to configure what action should be
1402 1403 1404 1405 1406 1407 1408 1409 1410 1411 1412 1413 1414 1415 1416 1417 1418 1419
      taken when a lock manager loses resource locks. The following
      actions are recognized by libvirt, although not all of them need
      to be supported by individual lock managers. When no action is
      specified, each lock manager will take its default action.
    </p>
    <dl>
      <dt><code>poweroff</code></dt>
      <dd>The domain will be forcefully powered off.</dd>
      <dt><code>restart</code></dt>
      <dd>The domain will be powered off and started up again to
        reacquire its locks.</dd>
      <dt><code>pause</code></dt>
      <dd>The domain will be paused so that it can be manually resumed
        when lock issues are solved.</dd>
      <dt><code>ignore</code></dt>
      <dd>Keep the domain running as if nothing happened.</dd>
    </dl>

1420 1421 1422 1423 1424 1425 1426 1427 1428 1429 1430 1431
    <h3><a name="elementsPowerManagement">Power Management</a></h3>

    <p>
      <span class="since">Since 0.10.2</span> it is possible to
      forcibly enable or disable BIOS advertisements to the guest
      OS. (NB: Only qemu driver support)
    </p>

<pre>
  ...
  &lt;pm&gt;
    &lt;suspend-to-disk enabled='no'/&gt;
1432
    &lt;suspend-to-mem enabled='yes'/&gt;
1433 1434 1435 1436 1437 1438 1439 1440 1441 1442 1443
  &lt;/pm&gt;
  ...</pre>

    <dl>
      <dt><code>pm</code></dt>
      <dd>These elements enable ('yes') or disable ('no') BIOS support
        for S3 (suspend-to-disk) and S4 (suspend-to-mem) ACPI sleep
        states. If nothing is specified, then the hypervisor will be
        left with its default value.</dd>
    </dl>

D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
1444 1445 1446 1447 1448 1449 1450
    <h3><a name="elementsFeatures">Hypervisor features</a></h3>

    <p>
      Hypervisors may allow certain CPU / machine features to be
      toggled on/off.
    </p>

1451 1452 1453 1454 1455 1456
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;features&gt;
    &lt;pae/&gt;
    &lt;acpi/&gt;
    &lt;apic/&gt;
J
Jim Fehlig 已提交
1457
    &lt;hap/&gt;
1458
    &lt;privnet/&gt;
1459
    &lt;hyperv&gt;
E
Eric Blake 已提交
1460
      &lt;relaxed state='on'/&gt;
1461
      &lt;vapic state='on'/&gt;
1462
      &lt;spinlocks state='on' retries='4096'/&gt;
1463
    &lt;/hyperv&gt;
1464 1465 1466
    &lt;kvm&gt;
      &lt;hidden state='on'/&gt;
    &lt;/kvm&gt;
1467
    &lt;pvspinlock state='on'/&gt;
M
Michal Privoznik 已提交
1468
    &lt;gic version='2'/&gt;
1469

1470 1471
  &lt;/features&gt;
  ...</pre>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
1472 1473 1474 1475 1476 1477 1478 1479 1480 1481 1482 1483

    <p>
      All features are listed within the <code>features</code>
      element, omitting a togglable feature tag turns it off.
      The available features can be found by asking
      for the <a href="formatcaps.html">capabilities XML</a>,
      but a common set for fully virtualized domains are:
    </p>

    <dl>
      <dt><code>pae</code></dt>
      <dd>Physical address extension mode allows 32-bit guests
M
Matthew Booth 已提交
1484
        to address more than 4 GB of memory.</dd>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
1485 1486
      <dt><code>acpi</code></dt>
      <dd>ACPI is useful for power management, for example, with
M
Matthew Booth 已提交
1487
        KVM guests it is required for graceful shutdown to work.
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
1488
      </dd>
1489 1490
      <dt><code>apic</code></dt>
      <dd>APIC allows the use of programmable IRQ
1491 1492 1493
      management. <span class="since">Since 0.10.2 (QEMU only)</span> there is
      an optional attribute <code>eoi</code> with values <code>on</code>
      and <code>off</code> which toggles the availability of EOI (End of
1494 1495
      Interrupt) for the guest.
      </dd>
J
Jim Fehlig 已提交
1496 1497 1498 1499
      <dt><code>hap</code></dt>
      <dd>Enable use of Hardware Assisted Paging if available in
        the hardware.
      </dd>
1500 1501 1502 1503
      <dt><code>viridian</code></dt>
      <dd>Enable Viridian hypervisor extensions for paravirtualizing
        guest operating systems
      </dd>
1504 1505 1506 1507 1508 1509
      <dt><code>privnet</code></dt>
      <dd>Always create a private network namespace. This is
        automatically set if any interface devices are defined.
        This feature is only relevant for container based
        virtualization drivers, such as LXC.
      </dd>
1510 1511 1512 1513 1514 1515 1516 1517
      <dt><code>hyperv</code></dt>
      <dd>Enable various features improving behavior of guests
        running Microsoft Windows.
      <table class="top_table">
        <tr>
          <th>Feature</th>
          <th>Description</th>
          <th>Value</th>
1518
          <th>Since</th>
1519 1520 1521
        </tr>
        <tr>
          <td>relaxed</td>
1522
          <td>Relax constraints on timers</td>
1523
          <td> on, off</td>
1524 1525 1526 1527 1528 1529 1530 1531 1532 1533 1534 1535 1536
          <td><span class="since">1.0.0 (QEMU only)</span></td>
        </tr>
        <tr>
          <td>vapic</td>
          <td>Enable virtual APIC</td>
          <td>on, off</td>
          <td><span class="since">1.1.0 (QEMU only)</span></td>
        </tr>
        <tr>
          <td>spinlocks</td>
          <td>Enable spinlock support</td>
          <td>on, off; retries - at least 4095</td>
          <td><span class="since">1.1.0 (QEMU only)</span></td>
1537 1538 1539
        </tr>
      </table>
      </dd>
1540 1541 1542 1543 1544 1545
      <dt><code>pvspinlock</code></dt>
      <dd>Notify the guest that the host supports paravirtual spinlocks
          for example by exposing the pvticketlocks mechanism. This feature
          can be explicitly disabled by using <code>state='off'</code>
          attribute.
      </dd>
1546 1547 1548 1549 1550 1551 1552 1553 1554 1555 1556 1557 1558 1559 1560 1561 1562
      <dt><code>kvm</code></dt>
      <dd>Various features to change the behavior of the KVM hypervisor.
      <table class="top_table">
        <tr>
          <th>Feature</th>
          <th>Description</th>
          <th>Value</th>
          <th>Since</th>
        </tr>
        <tr>
          <td>hidden</td>
          <td>Hide the KVM hypervisor from standard MSR based discovery</td>
          <td>on, off</td>
          <td><span class="since">2.1.0 (QEMU only)</span></td>
        </tr>
      </table>
      </dd>
1563 1564 1565 1566 1567 1568
      <dt><code>pmu</code></dt>
      <dd>Depending on the <code>state</code> attribute (values <code>on</code>,
        <code>off</code>, default <code>on</code>) enable or disable the
        performance monitoring unit for the guest.
        <span class="since">Since 1.2.12</span>
      </dd>
1569 1570 1571 1572 1573 1574
      <dt><code>vmport</code></dt>
      <dd>Depending on the <code>state</code> attribute (values <code>on</code>,
        <code>off</code>, default <code>on</code>) enable or disable
        the emulation of VMWare IO port, for vmmouse etc.
        <span class="since">Since 1.2.16</span>
      </dd>
M
Michal Privoznik 已提交
1575 1576 1577 1578 1579 1580 1581 1582 1583
      <dt><code>gic</code></dt>
      <dd>Enable for architectures using a General Interrupt
          Controller instead of APIC in order to handle interrupts.
          For example, the 'aarch64' architecture uses
          <code>gic</code> instead of <code>apic</code>. The optional
          attribute <code>version</code> specifies the GIC version;
          however, it may not be supported by all hypervisors. <span
          class="since">Since 1.2.16</span>
      </dd>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
1584 1585 1586 1587 1588 1589 1590 1591 1592 1593 1594
    </dl>

    <h3><a name="elementsTime">Time keeping</a></h3>

    <p>
      The guest clock is typically initialized from the host clock.
      Most operating systems expect the hardware clock to be kept
      in UTC, and this is the default. Windows, however, expects
      it to be in so called 'localtime'.
    </p>

1595 1596
<pre>
  ...
1597 1598 1599
  &lt;clock offset='localtime'&gt;
    &lt;timer name='rtc' tickpolicy='catchup' track='guest'&gt;
      &lt;catchup threshold='123' slew='120' limit='10000'/&gt;
1600
    &lt;/timer&gt;
1601
    &lt;timer name='pit' tickpolicy='delay'/&gt;
1602
  &lt;/clock&gt;
1603
  ...</pre>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
1604 1605 1606

    <dl>
      <dt><code>clock</code></dt>
1607
      <dd>
E
Eric Blake 已提交
1608 1609 1610 1611 1612 1613 1614 1615
        <p>The <code>offset</code> attribute takes four possible
          values, allowing fine grained control over how the guest
          clock is synchronized to the host. NB, not all hypervisors
          support all modes.</p>
        <dl>
          <dt><code>utc</code></dt>
          <dd>
            The guest clock will always be synchronized to UTC when
1616 1617 1618 1619 1620 1621 1622 1623 1624 1625 1626
            booted.
            <span class="since">Since 0.9.11</span> 'utc' mode can be converted
            to 'variable' mode, which can be controlled by using the
            <code>adjustment</code> attribute. If the value is 'reset', the
            conversion is never done (not all hypervisors can
            synchronize to UTC on each boot; use of 'reset' will cause
            an error on those hypervisors). A numeric value
            forces the conversion to 'variable' mode using the value as the
            initial adjustment. The default <code>adjustment</code> is
            hypervisor specific.
          </dd>
E
Eric Blake 已提交
1627 1628 1629 1630
          <dt><code>localtime</code></dt>
          <dd>
            The guest clock will be synchronized to the host's configured
            timezone when booted, if any.
1631 1632
            <span class="since">Since 0.9.11,</span> the <code>adjustment</code>
            attribute behaves the same as in 'utc' mode.
E
Eric Blake 已提交
1633 1634 1635 1636 1637 1638 1639 1640 1641 1642
          </dd>
          <dt><code>timezone</code></dt>
          <dd>
            The guest clock will be synchronized to the requested timezone
            using the <code>timezone</code> attribute.
            <span class="since">Since 0.7.7</span>
          </dd>
          <dt><code>variable</code></dt>
          <dd>
            The guest clock will have an arbitrary offset applied
1643 1644
            relative to UTC or localtime, depending on the <code>basis</code>
            attribute. The delta relative to UTC (or localtime) is specified
E
Eric Blake 已提交
1645
            in seconds, using the <code>adjustment</code> attribute.
P
Philipp Hahn 已提交
1646
            The guest is free to adjust the RTC over time and expect
1647 1648 1649
            that it will be honored at next reboot. This is in
            contrast to 'utc' and 'localtime' mode (with the optional
            attribute adjustment='reset'), where the RTC adjustments are
E
Eric Blake 已提交
1650
            lost at each reboot. <span class="since">Since 0.7.7</span>
1651 1652
            <span class="since">Since 0.9.11</span> the <code>basis</code>
            attribute can be either 'utc' (default) or 'localtime'.
E
Eric Blake 已提交
1653 1654 1655 1656
          </dd>
        </dl>
        <p>
          A <code>clock</code> may have zero or more
1657
          <code>timer</code> sub-elements. <span class="since">Since
E
Eric Blake 已提交
1658 1659
          0.8.0</span>
        </p>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
1660
      </dd>
1661 1662
      <dt><code>timer</code></dt>
      <dd>
E
Eric Blake 已提交
1663 1664 1665 1666 1667 1668 1669 1670 1671 1672
        <p>
          Each timer element requires a <code>name</code> attribute,
          and has other optional attributes that depend on
          the <code>name</code> specified.  Various hypervisors
          support different combinations of attributes.
        </p>
        <dl>
          <dt><code>name</code></dt>
          <dd>
            The <code>name</code> attribute selects which timer is
1673 1674 1675
            being modified, and can be one of
            "platform" (currently unsupported),
            "hpet" (libxl, xen, qemu), "kvmclock" (qemu),
1676 1677 1678 1679 1680 1681 1682
            "pit" (qemu), "rtc" (qemu), "tsc" (libxl) or "hypervclock"
            (qemu - <span class="since">since 1.2.2</span>).

            The <code>hypervclock</code> timer adds support for the
            reference time counter and the reference page for iTSC
            feature for guests running the Microsoft Windows
            operating system.
E
Eric Blake 已提交
1683 1684 1685 1686 1687 1688 1689 1690 1691 1692
          </dd>
          <dt><code>track</code></dt>
          <dd>
            The <code>track</code> attribute specifies what the timer
            tracks, and can be "boot", "guest", or "wall".
            Only valid for <code>name="rtc"</code>
            or <code>name="platform"</code>.
          </dd>
          <dt><code>tickpolicy</code></dt>
          <dd>
1693 1694
            <p>
            The <code>tickpolicy</code> attribute determines what
1695
            happens when QEMU misses a deadline for injecting a
1696 1697 1698 1699 1700 1701 1702 1703 1704 1705 1706 1707 1708 1709 1710 1711 1712 1713 1714 1715 1716 1717 1718
            tick to the guest:
            </p>
            <dl>
              <dt><code>delay</code></dt>
              <dd>Continue to deliver ticks at the normal rate.
                The guest time will be delayed due to the late
                tick</dd>
              <dt><code>catchup</code></dt>
              <dd>Deliver ticks at a higher rate to catch up
                with the missed tick. The guest time should
                not be delayed once catchup is complete.</dd>
              <dt><code>merge</code></dt>
              <dd>Merge the missed tick(s) into one tick and
                inject. The guest time may be delayed, depending
                on how the OS reacts to the merging of ticks</dd>
              <dt><code>discard</code></dt>
              <dd>Throw away the missed tick(s) and continue
                with future injection normally. The guest time
                may be delayed, unless the OS has explicit
                handling of lost ticks</dd>
            </dl>
            <p>If the policy is "catchup", there can be further details in
            the <code>catchup</code> sub-element.</p>
E
Eric Blake 已提交
1719 1720 1721 1722 1723 1724 1725 1726 1727
            <dl>
              <dt><code>catchup</code></dt>
              <dd>
                The <code>catchup</code> element has three optional
                attributes, each a positive integer.  The attributes
                are <code>threshold</code>, <code>slew</code>,
                and <code>limit</code>.
              </dd>
            </dl>
1728 1729 1730
            <p>
              Note that hypervisors are not required to support all policies across all time sources
            </p>
E
Eric Blake 已提交
1731 1732 1733 1734 1735 1736 1737 1738 1739 1740 1741 1742 1743 1744 1745 1746 1747 1748 1749 1750
          </dd>
          <dt><code>frequency</code></dt>
          <dd>
            The <code>frequency</code> attribute is an unsigned
            integer specifying the frequency at
            which <code>name="tsc"</code> runs.
          </dd>
          <dt><code>mode</code></dt>
          <dd>
            The <code>mode</code> attribute controls how
            the <code>name="tsc"</code> timer is managed, and can be
            "auto", "native", "emulate", "paravirt", or "smpsafe".
            Other timers are always emulated.
          </dd>
          <dt><code>present</code></dt>
          <dd>
            The <code>present</code> attribute can be "yes" or "no" to
            specify whether a particular timer is available to the guest.
          </dd>
        </dl>
1751
      </dd>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
1752 1753 1754 1755 1756
    </dl>

    <h3><a name="elementsDevices">Devices</a></h3>

    <p>
A
Atsushi SAKAI 已提交
1757
      The final set of XML elements are all used to describe devices
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
1758 1759 1760 1761 1762
      provided to the guest domain. All devices occur as children
      of the main <code>devices</code> element.
      <span class="since">Since 0.1.3</span>
    </p>

1763 1764 1765 1766 1767 1768
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;emulator&gt;/usr/lib/xen/bin/qemu-dm&lt;/emulator&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
1769 1770 1771 1772

    <dl>
      <dt><code>emulator</code></dt>
      <dd>
M
Matthew Booth 已提交
1773 1774 1775 1776 1777
        The contents of the <code>emulator</code> element specify
        the fully qualified path to the device model emulator binary.
        The <a href="formatcaps.html">capabilities XML</a> specifies
        the recommended default emulator to use for each particular
        domain type / architecture combination.
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
1778 1779 1780 1781 1782 1783 1784 1785 1786 1787 1788
      </dd>
    </dl>

    <h4><a name="elementsDisks">Hard drives, floppy disks, CDROMs</a></h4>

    <p>
      Any device that looks like a disk, be it a floppy, harddisk,
      cdrom, or paravirtualized driver is specified via the <code>disk</code>
      element.
    </p>

1789 1790 1791
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
1792
    &lt;disk type='file' snapshot='external'&gt;
1793
      &lt;driver name="tap" type="aio" cache="default"/&gt;
E
Eric Blake 已提交
1794
      &lt;source file='/var/lib/xen/images/fv0' startupPolicy='optional'&gt;
1795 1796
        &lt;seclabel relabel='no'/&gt;
      &lt;/source&gt;
1797
      &lt;target dev='hda' bus='ide'/&gt;
L
Lei Li 已提交
1798 1799 1800 1801 1802
      &lt;iotune&gt;
        &lt;total_bytes_sec&gt;10000000&lt;/total_bytes_sec&gt;
        &lt;read_iops_sec&gt;400000&lt;/read_iops_sec&gt;
        &lt;write_iops_sec&gt;100000&lt;/write_iops_sec&gt;
      &lt;/iotune&gt;
1803
      &lt;boot order='2'/&gt;
1804 1805 1806 1807
      &lt;encryption type='...'&gt;
        ...
      &lt;/encryption&gt;
      &lt;shareable/&gt;
1808 1809 1810
      &lt;serial&gt;
        ...
      &lt;/serial&gt;
1811
    &lt;/disk&gt;
M
MORITA Kazutaka 已提交
1812 1813
      ...
    &lt;disk type='network'&gt;
1814
      &lt;driver name="qemu" type="raw" io="threads" ioeventfd="on" event_idx="off"/&gt;
M
MORITA Kazutaka 已提交
1815 1816 1817 1818
      &lt;source protocol="sheepdog" name="image_name"&gt;
        &lt;host name="hostname" port="7000"/&gt;
      &lt;/source&gt;
      &lt;target dev="hdb" bus="ide"/&gt;
1819
      &lt;boot order='1'/&gt;
1820
      &lt;transient/&gt;
E
Eric Blake 已提交
1821
      &lt;address type='drive' controller='0' bus='1' unit='0'/&gt;
M
MORITA Kazutaka 已提交
1822
    &lt;/disk&gt;
1823 1824 1825 1826
    &lt;disk type='network'&gt;
      &lt;driver name="qemu" type="raw"/&gt;
      &lt;source protocol="rbd" name="image_name2"&gt;
        &lt;host name="hostname" port="7000"/&gt;
1827
        &lt;snapshot name="snapname"/&gt;
1828
        &lt;config file="/path/to/file"/&gt;
1829
      &lt;/source&gt;
1830
      &lt;target dev="hdc" bus="ide"/&gt;
1831 1832 1833 1834
      &lt;auth username='myuser'&gt;
        &lt;secret type='ceph' usage='mypassid'/&gt;
      &lt;/auth&gt;
    &lt;/disk&gt;
1835 1836
    &lt;disk type='block' device='cdrom'&gt;
      &lt;driver name='qemu' type='raw'/&gt;
1837
      &lt;target dev='hdd' bus='ide' tray='open'/&gt;
1838 1839
      &lt;readonly/&gt;
    &lt;/disk&gt;
1840 1841 1842 1843 1844
    &lt;disk type='network' device='cdrom'&gt;
      &lt;driver name='qemu' type='raw'/&gt;
      &lt;source protocol="http" name="url_path"&gt;
        &lt;host name="hostname" port="80"/&gt;
      &lt;/source&gt;
1845
      &lt;target dev='hde' bus='ide' tray='open'/&gt;
1846 1847
      &lt;readonly/&gt;
    &lt;/disk&gt;
1848 1849 1850 1851 1852
    &lt;disk type='network' device='cdrom'&gt;
      &lt;driver name='qemu' type='raw'/&gt;
      &lt;source protocol="https" name="url_path"&gt;
        &lt;host name="hostname" port="443"/&gt;
      &lt;/source&gt;
1853
      &lt;target dev='hdf' bus='ide' tray='open'/&gt;
1854 1855
      &lt;readonly/&gt;
    &lt;/disk&gt;
1856 1857 1858 1859 1860
    &lt;disk type='network' device='cdrom'&gt;
      &lt;driver name='qemu' type='raw'/&gt;
      &lt;source protocol="ftp" name="url_path"&gt;
        &lt;host name="hostname" port="21"/&gt;
      &lt;/source&gt;
1861
      &lt;target dev='hdg' bus='ide' tray='open'/&gt;
1862 1863
      &lt;readonly/&gt;
    &lt;/disk&gt;
1864 1865 1866 1867 1868
    &lt;disk type='network' device='cdrom'&gt;
      &lt;driver name='qemu' type='raw'/&gt;
      &lt;source protocol="ftps" name="url_path"&gt;
        &lt;host name="hostname" port="990"/&gt;
      &lt;/source&gt;
1869
      &lt;target dev='hdh' bus='ide' tray='open'/&gt;
1870 1871
      &lt;readonly/&gt;
    &lt;/disk&gt;
1872 1873 1874 1875 1876
    &lt;disk type='network' device='cdrom'&gt;
      &lt;driver name='qemu' type='raw'/&gt;
      &lt;source protocol="tftp" name="url_path"&gt;
        &lt;host name="hostname" port="69"/&gt;
      &lt;/source&gt;
1877
      &lt;target dev='hdi' bus='ide' tray='open'/&gt;
1878 1879
      &lt;readonly/&gt;
    &lt;/disk&gt;
1880 1881
    &lt;disk type='block' device='lun'&gt;
      &lt;driver name='qemu' type='raw'/&gt;
O
Osier Yang 已提交
1882 1883 1884
      &lt;source dev='/dev/sda'/&gt;
      &lt;target dev='sda' bus='scsi'/&gt;
      &lt;address type='drive' controller='0' bus='0' target='3' unit='0'/&gt;
1885
    &lt;/disk&gt;
J
J.B. Joret 已提交
1886 1887 1888 1889
    &lt;disk type='block' device='disk'&gt;
      &lt;driver name='qemu' type='raw'/&gt;
      &lt;source dev='/dev/sda'/&gt;
      &lt;geometry cyls='16383' heads='16' secs='63' trans='lba'/&gt;
V
Viktor Mihajlovski 已提交
1890
      &lt;blockio logical_block_size='512' physical_block_size='4096'/&gt;
1891
      &lt;target dev='hdj' bus='ide'/&gt;
J
J.B. Joret 已提交
1892
    &lt;/disk&gt;
1893 1894 1895
    &lt;disk type='volume' device='disk'&gt;
      &lt;driver name='qemu' type='raw'/&gt;
      &lt;source pool='blk-pool0' volume='blk-pool0-vol0'/&gt;
1896
      &lt;target dev='hdk' bus='ide'/&gt;
1897
    &lt;/disk&gt;
1898 1899 1900 1901 1902 1903
    &lt;disk type='network' device='disk'&gt;
      &lt;driver name='qemu' type='raw'/&gt;
      &lt;source protocol='iscsi' name='iqn.2013-07.com.example:iscsi-nopool/2'&gt;
        &lt;host name='example.com' port='3260'/&gt;
      &lt;/source&gt;
      &lt;auth username='myuser'&gt;
1904
        &lt;secret type='iscsi' usage='libvirtiscsi'/&gt;
1905 1906 1907 1908 1909 1910 1911 1912 1913
      &lt;/auth&gt;
      &lt;target dev='vda' bus='virtio'/&gt;
    &lt;/disk&gt;
    &lt;disk type='network' device='lun'&gt;
      &lt;driver name='qemu' type='raw'/&gt;
      &lt;source protocol='iscsi' name='iqn.2013-07.com.example:iscsi-nopool/1'&gt;
        &lt;host name='example.com' port='3260'/&gt;
      &lt;/source&gt;
      &lt;auth username='myuser'&gt;
1914
        &lt;secret type='iscsi' usage='libvirtiscsi'/&gt;
1915
      &lt;/auth&gt;
1916
      &lt;target dev='sdb' bus='scsi'/&gt;
1917 1918 1919 1920 1921
    &lt;/disk&gt;
    &lt;disk type='volume' device='disk'&gt;
      &lt;driver name='qemu' type='raw'/&gt;
      &lt;source pool='iscsi-pool' volume='unit:0:0:1' mode='host'/&gt;
      &lt;auth username='myuser'&gt;
1922
        &lt;secret type='iscsi' usage='libvirtiscsi'/&gt;
1923
      &lt;/auth&gt;
1924
      &lt;target dev='vdb' bus='virtio'/&gt;
1925 1926 1927 1928 1929
    &lt;/disk&gt;
    &lt;disk type='volume' device='disk'&gt;
      &lt;driver name='qemu' type='raw'/&gt;
      &lt;source pool='iscsi-pool' volume='unit:0:0:2' mode='direct'/&gt;
      &lt;auth username='myuser'&gt;
1930
        &lt;secret type='iscsi' usage='libvirtiscsi'/&gt;
1931
      &lt;/auth&gt;
1932
      &lt;target dev='vdc' bus='virtio'/&gt;
1933
    &lt;/disk&gt;
1934 1935 1936 1937 1938 1939 1940 1941 1942 1943 1944 1945
    &lt;disk type='file' device='disk'&gt;
      &lt;driver name='qemu' type='qcow2'/&gt;
      &lt;source file='/var/lib/libvirt/images/domain.qcow'/&gt;
      &lt;backingStore type='file'&gt;
        &lt;format type='qcow2'/&gt;
        &lt;source file='/var/lib/libvirt/images/snapshot.qcow'/&gt;
        &lt;backingStore type='block'&gt;
          &lt;format type='raw'/&gt;
          &lt;source dev='/dev/mapper/base'/&gt;
          &lt;backingStore/&gt;
        &lt;/backingStore&gt;
      &lt;/backingStore&gt;
1946
      &lt;target dev='vdd' bus='virtio'/&gt;
1947
    &lt;/disk&gt;
1948 1949
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
1950 1951 1952 1953

    <dl>
      <dt><code>disk</code></dt>
      <dd>The <code>disk</code> element is the main container for describing
1954 1955 1956 1957 1958 1959 1960 1961 1962 1963 1964 1965 1966 1967 1968 1969 1970 1971 1972
      disks (<span class="since">since 0.0.3</span>).
        <dl>
          <dt><code>type</code> attribute
          <span class="since">since 0.0.3</span></dt>
            <dd>
            Valid values are "file", "block",
            "dir" (<span class="since">since 0.7.5</span>),
            "network" (<span class="since">since 0.8.7</span>), or
            "volume" (<span class="since">since 1.0.5</span>)
            and refer to the underlying source for the disk.
            </dd>
          <dt><code>device</code> attribute
          <span class="since">since 0.1.4</span></dt>
            <dd>
            Indicates how the disk is to be exposed to the guest OS. Possible
            values for this attribute are "floppy", "disk", "cdrom", and "lun",
            defaulting to "disk".
            <p>
            Using "lun" (<span class="since">since 0.9.10</span>) is only
1973 1974
            valid when the <code>type</code> is "block" or "network" for
            <code>protocol='iscsi'</code> or when the <code>type</code>
1975
            is "volume" when using an iSCSI source <code>pool</code>
1976 1977 1978
            for <code>mode</code> "host" or as an
            <a href="http://wiki.libvirt.org/page/NPIV_in_libvirt">NPIV</a>
            virtual Host Bus Adapter (vHBA) using a Fibre Channel storage pool.
1979
            Configured in this manner, the LUN behaves identically to "disk",
1980 1981 1982 1983 1984 1985 1986 1987 1988 1989 1990
            except that generic SCSI commands from the guest are accepted
            and passed through to the physical device. Also note that
            device='lun' will only be recognized for actual raw devices,
            but never for individual partitions or LVM partitions (in those
            cases, the kernel will reject the generic SCSI commands, making
            it identical to device='disk').
            </p>
            </dd>
          <dt><code>rawio</code> attribute
          <span class="since">since 0.9.10</span></dt>
            <dd>
1991
            Indicates whether the disk needs rawio capability. Valid
1992 1993 1994 1995 1996 1997 1998 1999 2000 2001 2002 2003 2004 2005 2006
            settings are "yes" or "no" (default is "no"). If any one disk
            in a domain has rawio='yes', rawio capability will be enabled
            for all disks in the domain (because, in the case of QEMU, this
            capability can only be set on a per-process basis). This attribute
            is only valid when device is "lun". NB, <code>rawio</code> intends
            to confine the capability per-device, however, current QEMU
            implementation gives the domain process broader capability
            than that (per-process basis, affects all the domain disks).
            To confine the capability as much as possible for QEMU driver
            as this stage, <code>sgio</code> is recommended, it's more
            secure than <code>rawio</code>.
            </dd>
          <dt><code>sgio</code> attribute
          <span class="since">since 1.0.2</span></dt>
            <dd>
2007 2008 2009 2010
            If supported by the hypervisor and OS, indicates whether
            unprivileged SG_IO commands are filtered for the disk. Valid
            settings are "filtered" or "unfiltered" where the default is
            "filtered". Only available when the <code>device</code> is 'lun'.
2011 2012 2013 2014 2015 2016 2017 2018 2019 2020 2021 2022 2023 2024 2025 2026 2027 2028 2029
            </dd>
          <dt><code>snapshot</code> attribute
          <span class="since">since 0.9.5</span></dt>
            <dd>
            Indicates the default behavior of the disk during disk snapshots:
            "internal" requires a file format such as qcow2 that can store
            both the snapshot and the data changes since the snapshot;
            "external" will separate the snapshot from the live data; and
            "no" means the disk will not participate in snapshots. Read-only
            disks default to "no", while the default for other disks depends
            on the hypervisor's capabilities.  Some hypervisors allow a
            per-snapshot choice as well, during
            <a href="formatsnapshot.html">domain snapshot creation</a>.
            Not all snapshot modes are supported; for example,
            <code>snapshot='yes'</code> with a transient disk generally
            does not make sense.
            </dd>
        </dl>
      </dd>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
2030
      <dt><code>source</code></dt>
2031 2032 2033 2034 2035 2036 2037 2038 2039 2040 2041 2042
      <dd>Representation of the disk <code>source</code> depends on the
      disk <code>type</code> attribute value as follows:
          <dl>
            <dt><code>type='file'</code>
            <span class="since">since 0.0.3</span></dt>
              <dd>
              The <code>file</code> attribute specifies the fully-qualified
              path to the file holding the disk.
              </dd>
            <dt><code>type='block'</code>
            <span class="since">since 0.0.3</span></dt>
              <dd>
2043 2044
              The <code>dev</code> attribute specifies the fully-qualified path
              to the host device to serve as the disk.
2045 2046 2047 2048 2049 2050 2051 2052 2053 2054 2055 2056 2057 2058 2059 2060 2061 2062 2063 2064 2065 2066 2067 2068 2069 2070 2071 2072 2073 2074 2075 2076 2077 2078 2079 2080 2081 2082 2083 2084 2085 2086 2087 2088 2089 2090 2091 2092 2093 2094 2095
              </dd>
            <dt><code>type='dir'</code>
            <span class="since">since 0.7.5</span></dt>
              <dd>
              The <code>dir</code> attribute specifies the fully-qualified path
              to the directory to use as the disk.
              </dd>
            <dt><code>type='network'</code>
            <span class="since">since 0.8.7</span></dt>
              <dd>
              The <code>protocol</code> attribute specifies the protocol to
              access to the requested image. Possible values are "nbd",
              "iscsi", "rbd", "sheepdog" or "gluster".  If the
              <code>protocol</code> attribute is "rbd", "sheepdog" or
              "gluster", an additional attribute <code>name</code> is
              mandatory to specify which volume/image will be used. For "nbd",
              the <code>name</code> attribute is optional. For "iscsi"
              (<span class="since">since 1.0.4</span>), the <code>name</code>
              attribute may include a logical unit number, separated from the
              target's name by a slash (e.g.,
              <code>iqn.2013-07.com.example:iscsi-pool/1</code>). If not
              specified, the default LUN is zero.
              </dd>
            <dt><code>type='volume'</code>
            <span class="since">since 1.0.5</span></dt>
              <dd>
              The underlying disk source is represented by attributes
              <code>pool</code> and <code>volume</code>. Attribute
              <code>pool</code> specifies the name of the
              <a href="formatstorage.html">storage pool</a> (managed
              by libvirt) where the disk source resides. Attribute
              <code>volume</code> specifies the name of storage volume (managed
              by libvirt) used as the disk source. The value for the
              <code>volume</code> attribute will be the output from the "Name"
              column of a <code>virsh vol-list [pool-name]</code> command.
              <p>
              Use the attribute <code>mode</code>
              (<span class="since">since 1.1.1</span>) to indicate how to
              represent the LUN as the disk source. Valid values are
              "direct" and "host". If <code>mode</code> is not specified,
              the default is to use "host".

              Using "direct" as the <code>mode</code> value indicates to use
              the <a href="formatstorage.html">storage pool's</a>
              <code>source</code> element <code>host</code> attribute as
              the disk source to generate the libiscsi URI (e.g.
              'file=iscsi://example.com:3260/iqn.2013-07.com.example:iscsi-pool/1').

              Using "host" as the <code>mode</code> value indicates to use the
              LUN's path as it shows up on host (e.g.
              'file=/dev/disk/by-path/ip-example.com:3260-iscsi-iqn.2013-07.com.example:iscsi-pool-lun-1').
2096 2097 2098 2099 2100 2101 2102

              Using a LUN from an iSCSI source pool provides the same
              features as a <code>disk</code> configured using
              <code>type</code> 'block' or 'network and <code>device</code>
              of 'lun' with respect to how the LUN is presented to and
              may used by the guest.

2103 2104 2105 2106
              </p>
              </dd>
          </dl>
        With "file", "block", and "volume", one or more optional
2107
        sub-elements <code>seclabel</code>, <a href="#seclabel">described
2108 2109
        below</a> (and <span class="since">since 0.9.9</span>), can be
        used to override the domain security labeling policy for just
2110 2111
        that source file. (NB, for "volume" type disk, <code>seclabel</code>
        is only valid when the specified storage volume is of 'file' or
2112 2113
        'block' type).
        <p>
2114
        The <code>source</code> element may contain the following sub elements:
2115
        </p>
2116 2117 2118 2119 2120

        <dl>
          <dt><code>host</code></dt>
          <dd>
            <p>
2121 2122 2123 2124
            When the disk <code>type</code> is "network", the <code>source</code>
            may have zero or more <code>host</code> sub-elements used to
            specify the hosts to connect.

2125 2126 2127 2128 2129 2130 2131 2132 2133 2134 2135 2136 2137 2138 2139 2140 2141 2142 2143 2144 2145 2146 2147 2148 2149 2150 2151 2152 2153
            The <code>host</code> element supports 4 attributes, viz.  "name",
            "port", "transport" and "socket", which specify the hostname,
            the port number, transport type and path to socket, respectively.
            The meaning of this element and the number of the elements depend
            on the protocol attribute.
            </p>
            <table class="top_table">
              <tr>
                <th> Protocol </th>
                <th> Meaning </th>
                <th> Number of hosts </th>
                <th> Default port </th>
              </tr>
              <tr>
                <td> nbd </td>
                <td> a server running nbd-server </td>
                <td> only one </td>
                <td> 10809 </td>
              </tr>
              <tr>
                <td> iscsi </td>
                <td> an iSCSI server </td>
                <td> only one </td>
                <td> 3260 </td>
              </tr>
              <tr>
                <td> rbd </td>
                <td> monitor servers of RBD </td>
                <td> one or more </td>
2154
                <td> librados default </td>
2155 2156 2157 2158 2159 2160 2161 2162 2163 2164 2165 2166 2167 2168 2169 2170 2171 2172 2173 2174 2175 2176
              </tr>
              <tr>
                <td> sheepdog </td>
                <td> one of the sheepdog servers (default is localhost:7000) </td>
                <td> zero or one </td>
                <td> 7000 </td>
              </tr>
              <tr>
                <td> gluster </td>
                <td> a server running glusterd daemon </td>
                <td> only one </td>
                <td> 24007 </td>
              </tr>
            </table>
            <p>
            gluster supports "tcp", "rdma", "unix" as valid values for the
            transport attribute.  nbd supports "tcp" and "unix".  Others only
            support "tcp".  If nothing is specified, "tcp" is assumed. If the
            transport is "unix", the socket attribute specifies the path to an
            AF_UNIX socket.
            </p>
          </dd>
2177 2178 2179 2180 2181 2182 2183
          <dt><code>snapshot</code></dt>
          <dd>
            The <code>name</code> attribute of <code>snapshot</code> element can
            optionally specify an internal snapshot name to be used as the
            source for storage protocols.
            Supported for 'rbd' <span class="since">since 1.2.11 (QEMU only).</span>
          </dd>
2184 2185 2186 2187 2188 2189 2190 2191
          <dt><code>config</code></dt>
          <dd>
            The <code>file</code> attribute for the <code>config</code> element
            provides a fully qualified path to a configuration file to be
            provided as a parameter to the client of a networked storage
            protocol. Supported for 'rbd' <span class="since">since 1.2.11
            (QEMU only).</span>
          </dd>
2192 2193
        </dl>

2194
        <p>
2195
        For a "file" or "volume" disk type which represents a cdrom or floppy
2196 2197
        (the <code>device</code> attribute), it is possible to define
        policy what to do with the disk if the source file is not accessible.
2198 2199
        (NB, <code>startupPolicy</code> is not valid for "volume" disk unless
         the specified storage volume is of "file" type). This is done by the
2200 2201
        <code>startupPolicy</code> attribute
        (<span class="since">since 0.9.7</span>),
2202
        accepting these values:
2203
        </p>
2204 2205 2206 2207 2208 2209 2210 2211 2212 2213 2214 2215 2216 2217 2218
        <table class="top_table">
          <tr>
            <td> mandatory </td>
            <td> fail if missing for any reason (the default) </td>
          </tr>
          <tr>
            <td> requisite </td>
            <td> fail if missing on boot up,
                 drop if missing on migrate/restore/revert </td>
          </tr>
          <tr>
            <td> optional </td>
            <td> drop if missing at any start attempt </td>
          </tr>
        </table>
2219 2220 2221 2222 2223 2224 2225
        <p>
        <span class="since">Since 1.1.2</span> the <code>startupPolicy</code>
        is extended to support hard disks besides cdrom and floppy. On guest
        cold bootup, if a certain disk is not accessible or its disk chain is
        broken, with startupPolicy 'optional' the guest will drop this disk.
        This feature doesn't support migration currently.
        </p>
2226
        </dd>
2227 2228
      <dt><code>backingStore</code></dt>
      <dd>
D
Deepak Shetty 已提交
2229 2230 2231 2232 2233 2234 2235 2236 2237 2238 2239 2240 2241 2242 2243 2244
        This element describes the backing store used by the disk
        specified by sibling <code>source</code> element. It is
        currently ignored on input and only used for output to
        describe the detected backing chains of running
        domains <span class="since">since 1.2.4</span> (although a
        future version of libvirt may start accepting chains on input,
        or output information for offline domains). An
        empty <code>backingStore</code> element means the sibling
        source is self-contained and is not based on any backing
        store. For backing chain information to be accurate, the
        backing format must be correctly specified in the metadata of
        each file of the chain (files created by libvirt satisfy this
        property, but using existing external files for snapshot or
        block copy operations requires the end user to pre-create the
        file correctly). The following attributes and sub-elements are
        supported in <code>backingStore</code>:
2245 2246 2247 2248 2249 2250 2251 2252 2253 2254 2255 2256 2257 2258 2259 2260 2261 2262 2263 2264 2265 2266 2267 2268 2269 2270 2271 2272 2273 2274 2275 2276 2277 2278 2279 2280 2281
        <dl>
          <dt><code>type</code> attribute</dt>
          <dd>
            The <code>type</code> attribute represents the type of disk used
            by the backing store, see disk type attribute above for more
            details and possible values.
          </dd>
          <dt><code>index</code> attribute</dt>
          <dd>
            This attribute is only valid in output (and ignored on input) and
            it can be used to refer to a specific part of the disk chain when
            doing block operations (such as via the
            <code>virDomainBlockRebase</code> API). For example,
            <code>vda[2]</code> refers to the backing store with
            <code>index='2'</code> of the disk with <code>vda</code> target.
          </dd>
          <dt><code>format</code> sub-element</dt>
          <dd>
            The <code>format</code> element contains <code>type</code>
            attribute which specifies the internal format of the backing
            store, such as <code>raw</code> or <code>qcow2</code>.
          </dd>
          <dt><code>source</code> sub-element</dt>
          <dd>
            This element has the same structure as the <code>source</code>
            element in <code>disk</code>. It specifies which file, device,
            or network location contains the data of the described backing
            store.
          </dd>
          <dt><code>backingStore</code> sub-element</dt>
          <dd>
            If the backing store is not self-contained, the next element
            in the chain is described by nested <code>backingStore</code>
            element.
          </dd>
        </dl>
      </dd>
2282 2283
      <dt><code>mirror</code></dt>
      <dd>
E
Eric Blake 已提交
2284 2285 2286 2287
        This element is present if the hypervisor has started a
        long-running block job operation, where the mirror location in
        the <code>source</code> sub-element will eventually have the
        same contents as the source, and with the file format in the
E
Eric Blake 已提交
2288 2289 2290 2291
        sub-element <code>format</code> (which might differ from the
        format of the source).  The details of the <code>source</code>
        sub-element are determined by the <code>type</code> attribute
        of the mirror, similar to what is done for the
E
Eric Blake 已提交
2292 2293 2294 2295 2296
        overall <code>disk</code> device element. The <code>job</code>
        attribute mentions which API started the operation ("copy" for
        the <code>virDomainBlockRebase</code> API, or "active-commit"
        for the <code>virDomainBlockCommit</code>
        API), <span class="since">since 1.2.7</span>.  The
2297 2298 2299 2300 2301 2302
        attribute <code>ready</code>, if present, tracks progress of
        the job: <code>yes</code> if the disk is known to be ready to
        pivot, or, <span class="since">since
        1.2.7</span>, <code>abort</code> or <code>pivot</code> if the
        job is in the process of completing.  If <code>ready</code> is
        not present, the disk is probably still
2303
        copying.  For now, this element only valid in output; it is
2304 2305 2306 2307 2308 2309 2310
        ignored on input.  The <code>source</code> sub-element exists
        for all two-phase jobs <span class="since">since 1.2.6</span>.
        Older libvirt supported only block copy to a
        file, <span class="since">since 0.9.12</span>; for
        compatibility with older clients, such jobs include redundant
        information in the attributes <code>file</code>
        and <code>format</code> in the <code>mirror</code> element.
2311
      </dd>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
2312
      <dt><code>target</code></dt>
E
Eric Blake 已提交
2313 2314 2315 2316 2317 2318 2319 2320
      <dd>The <code>target</code> element controls the bus / device
        under which the disk is exposed to the guest
        OS. The <code>dev</code> attribute indicates the "logical"
        device name. The actual device name specified is not
        guaranteed to map to the device name in the guest OS. Treat it
        as a device ordering hint.  The optional <code>bus</code>
        attribute specifies the type of disk device to emulate;
        possible values are driver specific, with typical values being
2321 2322
        "ide", "scsi", "virtio", "xen", "usb", "sata", or
        "sd" <span class="since">"sd" since 1.1.2</span>. If omitted, the bus
M
Martin Kletzander 已提交
2323 2324
        type is inferred from the style of the device name (e.g. a device named
        'sda' will typically be exported using a SCSI bus). The optional
2325 2326 2327 2328
        attribute <code>tray</code> indicates the tray status of the
        removable disks (i.e. CDROM or Floppy disk), the value can be either
        "open" or "closed", defaults to "closed". NB, the value of
        <code>tray</code> could be updated while the domain is running.
2329 2330 2331 2332
        The optional attribute <code>removable</code> sets the
        removable flag for USB disks, and its value can be either "on"
        or "off", defaulting to "off". <span class="since">Since
        0.0.3; <code>bus</code> attribute since 0.4.3;
2333
        <code>tray</code> attribute since 0.9.11; "usb" attribute value since
2334 2335
        after 0.4.4; "sata" attribute value since 0.9.7; "removable" attribute
        value since 1.1.3</span>
2336
      </dd>
L
Lei Li 已提交
2337 2338 2339 2340 2341 2342 2343 2344 2345 2346 2347 2348 2349 2350 2351 2352 2353 2354 2355 2356 2357 2358 2359 2360 2361 2362 2363 2364 2365 2366 2367 2368 2369
      <dt><code>iotune</code></dt>
      <dd>The optional <code>iotune</code> element provides the
        ability to provide additional per-device I/O tuning, with
        values that can vary for each device (contrast this to
        the <a href="#elementsBlockTuning"><code>&lt;blkiotune&gt;</code></a>
        element, which applies globally to the domain).  Currently,
        the only tuning available is Block I/O throttling for qemu.
        This element has optional sub-elements; any sub-element not
        specified or given with a value of 0 implies no
        limit.  <span class="since">Since 0.9.8</span>
        <dl>
          <dt><code>total_bytes_sec</code></dt>
          <dd>The optional <code>total_bytes_sec</code> element is the
            total throughput limit in bytes per second.  This cannot
            appear with <code>read_bytes_sec</code>
            or <code>write_bytes_sec</code>.</dd>
          <dt><code>read_bytes_sec</code></dt>
          <dd>The optional <code>read_bytes_sec</code> element is the
            read throughput limit in bytes per second.</dd>
          <dt><code>write_bytes_sec</code></dt>
          <dd>The optional <code>write_bytes_sec</code> element is the
            write throughput limit in bytes per second.</dd>
          <dt><code>total_iops_sec</code></dt>
          <dd>The optional <code>total_iops_sec</code> element is the
            total I/O operations per second.  This cannot
            appear with <code>read_iops_sec</code>
            or <code>write_iops_sec</code>.</dd>
          <dt><code>read_iops_sec</code></dt>
          <dd>The optional <code>read_iops_sec</code> element is the
            read I/O operations per second.</dd>
          <dt><code>write_iops_sec</code></dt>
          <dd>The optional <code>write_iops_sec</code> element is the
            write I/O operations per second.</dd>
2370 2371 2372 2373 2374 2375 2376 2377 2378 2379 2380 2381 2382 2383 2384 2385 2386 2387 2388 2389 2390 2391 2392 2393 2394
          <dt><code>total_bytes_sec_max</code></dt>
          <dd>The optional <code>total_bytes_sec_max</code> element is the
            maximum total throughput limit in bytes per second.  This cannot
            appear with <code>read_bytes_sec_max</code>
            or <code>write_bytes_sec_max</code>.</dd>
          <dt><code>read_bytes_sec_max</code></dt>
          <dd>The optional <code>read_bytes_sec_max</code> element is the
            maximum read throughput limit in bytes per second.</dd>
          <dt><code>write_bytes_sec_max</code></dt>
          <dd>The optional <code>write_bytes_sec_max</code> element is the
            maximum write throughput limit in bytes per second.</dd>
          <dt><code>total_iops_sec_max</code></dt>
          <dd>The optional <code>total_iops_sec_max</code> element is the
            maximum total I/O operations per second.  This cannot
            appear with <code>read_iops_sec_max</code>
            or <code>write_iops_sec_max</code>.</dd>
          <dt><code>read_iops_sec_max</code></dt>
          <dd>The optional <code>read_iops_sec_max</code> element is the
            maximum read I/O operations per second.</dd>
          <dt><code>write_iops_sec_max</code></dt>
          <dd>The optional <code>write_iops_sec_max</code> element is the
            maximum write I/O operations per second.</dd>
          <dt><code>size_iops_sec</code></dt>
          <dd>The optional <code>size_iops_sec</code> element is the
            size of I/O operations per second.</dd>
L
Lei Li 已提交
2395
        </dl>
2396
      </dd>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
2397
      <dt><code>driver</code></dt>
M
Matthias Dahl 已提交
2398 2399 2400
      <dd>
        The optional driver element allows specifying further details
        related to the hypervisor driver used to provide the disk.
2401
        <span class="since">Since 0.1.8</span>
M
Matthias Dahl 已提交
2402 2403 2404 2405 2406 2407 2408 2409 2410 2411 2412 2413 2414 2415
        <ul>
          <li>
            If the hypervisor supports multiple backend drivers, then
            the <code>name</code> attribute selects the primary
            backend driver name, while the optional <code>type</code>
            attribute provides the sub-type.  For example, xen
            supports a name of "tap", "tap2", "phy", or "file", with a
            type of "aio", while qemu only supports a name of "qemu",
            but multiple types including "raw", "bochs", "qcow2", and
            "qed".
          </li>
          <li>
            The optional <code>cache</code> attribute controls the
            cache mechanism, possible values are "default", "none",
2416 2417 2418 2419 2420 2421 2422 2423 2424
            "writethrough", "writeback", "directsync" (like
            "writethrough", but it bypasses the host page cache) and
            "unsafe" (host may cache all disk io, and sync requests from
            guest are ignored).
            <span class="since">
              Since 0.6.0,
              "directsync" since 0.9.5,
              "unsafe" since 0.9.7
            </span>
M
Matthias Dahl 已提交
2425 2426 2427
          </li>
          <li>
            The optional <code>error_policy</code> attribute controls
2428 2429 2430 2431 2432 2433 2434
            how the hypervisor will behave on a disk read or write
            error, possible values are "stop", "report", "ignore", and
            "enospace".<span class="since">Since 0.8.0, "report" since
            0.9.7</span> The default setting of error_policy is "report".
            There is also an
            optional <code>rerror_policy</code> that controls behavior
            for read errors only. <span class="since">Since
E
Eric Blake 已提交
2435
            0.9.7</span>. If no rerror_policy is given, error_policy
2436 2437 2438 2439 2440 2441 2442
            is used for both read and write errors. If rerror_policy
            is given, it overrides the <code>error_policy</code> for
            read errors. Also note that "enospace" is not a valid
            policy for read errors, so if <code>error_policy</code> is
            set to "enospace" and no <code>rerror_policy</code> is
            given, the read error policy will be left at its default,
            which is "report".
M
Matthias Dahl 已提交
2443 2444 2445 2446
          </li>
          <li>
            The optional <code>io</code> attribute controls specific
            policies on I/O; qemu guests support "threads" and
2447
            "native". <span class="since">Since 0.8.8</span>
M
Matthias Dahl 已提交
2448
          </li>
2449 2450 2451 2452 2453 2454 2455 2456 2457 2458 2459 2460 2461 2462
          <li>
            The optional <code>ioeventfd</code> attribute allows users to
            set <a href='https://patchwork.kernel.org/patch/43390/'>
            domain I/O asynchronous handling</a> for disk device.
            The default is left to the discretion of the hypervisor.
            Accepted values are "on" and "off". Enabling this allows
            qemu to execute VM while a separate thread handles I/O.
            Typically guests experiencing high system CPU utilization
            during I/O will benefit from this. On the other hand,
            on overloaded host it could increase guest I/O latency.
            <span class="since">Since 0.9.3 (QEMU and KVM only)</span>
            <b>In general you should leave this option alone, unless you
            are very certain you know what you are doing.</b>
          </li>
2463 2464 2465 2466
          <li>
            The optional <code>event_idx</code> attribute controls
            some aspects of device event processing. The value can be
            either 'on' or 'off' - if it is on, it will reduce the
2467
            number of interrupts and exits for the guest. The default
2468 2469 2470 2471 2472 2473 2474 2475
            is determined by QEMU; usually if the feature is
            supported, default is on. In case there is a situation
            where this behavior is suboptimal, this attribute provides
            a way to force the feature off.
            <span class="since">Since 0.9.5 (QEMU and KVM only)</span>
            <b>In general you should leave this option alone, unless you
            are very certain you know what you are doing.</b>
          </li>
O
Osier Yang 已提交
2476 2477
          <li>
            The optional <code>copy_on_read</code> attribute controls
2478
            whether to copy read backing file into the image file. The
O
Osier Yang 已提交
2479 2480 2481 2482 2483 2484
            value can be either "on" or "off".
            Copy-on-read avoids accessing the same backing file sectors
            repeatedly and is useful when the backing file is over a slow
            network. By default copy-on-read is off.
            <span class='since'>Since 0.9.10 (QEMU and KVM only)</span>
          </li>
O
Osier Yang 已提交
2485 2486 2487 2488
          <li>
            The optional <code>discard</code> attribute controls whether
            to discard (also known as "trim" or "unmap") requests are
            ignored or passed to the filesystem. The value can be either
O
Osier Yang 已提交
2489 2490
            "unmap" (allow the discard request to be passed) or "ignore"
            (ignore the discard request).
O
Osier Yang 已提交
2491 2492
            <span class='since'>Since 1.0.6 (QEMU and KVM only)</span>
          </li>
2493 2494 2495 2496 2497 2498 2499 2500
          <li>
            The optional <code>iothread</code> attribute assigns the
            disk to an IOThread as defined by the range for the domain
            <a href="#elementsIOThreadsAllocation"><code>iothreads</code></a>
            value. Multiple devices may be assigned to the same IOThread and
            are numbered from 1 to the domain iothreads value.
            <span class='since'>Since 1.2.8 (QEMU only)</span>
          </li>
M
Matthias Dahl 已提交
2501
        </ul>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
2502
      </dd>
2503 2504 2505 2506 2507 2508
      <dt><code>backenddomain</code></dt>
      <dd>The optional <code>backenddomain</code> element allows specifying a
          backend domain (aka driver domain) hosting the disk.  Use the
          <code>name</code> attribute to specify the backend domain name.
          <span class="since">Since 1.2.13 (Xen only)</span>
      </dd>
2509 2510 2511 2512 2513 2514 2515 2516
      <dt><code>boot</code></dt>
      <dd>Specifies that the disk is bootable. The <code>order</code>
        attribute determines the order in which devices will be tried during
        boot sequence. The per-device <code>boot</code> elements cannot be
        used together with general boot elements in
        <a href="#elementsOSBIOS">BIOS bootloader</a> section.
        <span class="since">Since 0.8.8</span>
      </dd>
2517 2518 2519 2520 2521
      <dt><code>encryption</code></dt>
      <dd>If present, specifies how the volume is encrypted.  See
        the <a href="formatstorageencryption.html">Storage Encryption</a> page
        for more information.
      </dd>
2522 2523 2524
      <dt><code>readonly</code></dt>
      <dd>If present, this indicates the device cannot be modified by
        the guest.  For now, this is the default for disks with
2525
        attribute <code>device='cdrom'</code>.
2526
      </dd>
2527 2528 2529 2530 2531
      <dt><code>shareable</code></dt>
      <dd>If present, this indicates the device is expected to be shared
          between domains (assuming the hypervisor and OS support this),
          which means that caching should be deactivated for that device.
      </dd>
2532 2533 2534 2535 2536 2537 2538
      <dt><code>transient</code></dt>
      <dd>If present, this indicates that changes to the device
        contents should be reverted automatically when the guest
        exits.  With some hypervisors, marking a disk transient
        prevents the domain from participating in migration or
        snapshots. <span class="since">Since 0.9.5</span>
      </dd>
2539 2540
      <dt><code>serial</code></dt>
      <dd>If present, this specify serial number of virtual hard drive.
E
Eric Blake 已提交
2541 2542
          For example, it may look
          like <code>&lt;serial&gt;WD-WMAP9A966149&lt;/serial&gt;</code>.
2543 2544 2545
          Not supported for scsi-block devices, that is those using
          disk <code>type</code> 'block' using <code>device</code> 'lun'
          on <code>bus</code> 'scsi'.
2546 2547
          <span class="since">Since 0.7.1</span>
      </dd>
O
Osier Yang 已提交
2548 2549 2550
      <dt><code>wwn</code></dt>
      <dd>If present, this element specifies the WWN (World Wide Name)
        of a virtual hard disk or CD-ROM drive. It must be composed
2551 2552
        of 16 hexadecimal digits and must be unique (at least among
        disks of a single domain)
O
Osier Yang 已提交
2553 2554
        <span class='since'>Since 0.10.1</span>
      </dd>
2555 2556 2557 2558 2559 2560 2561 2562 2563 2564 2565 2566
      <dt><code>vendor</code></dt>
      <dd>If present, this element specifies the vendor of a virtual hard
        disk or CD-ROM device. It must not be longer than 8 printable
        characters.
        <span class='since'>Since 1.0.1</span>
      </dd>
      <dt><code>product</code></dt>
      <dd>If present, this element specifies the product of a virtual hard
        disk or CD-ROM device. It must not be longer than 16 printable
        characters.
        <span class='since'>Since 1.0.1</span>
      </dd>
E
Eric Blake 已提交
2567 2568 2569 2570 2571 2572 2573 2574 2575
      <dt><code>address</code></dt>
      <dd>If present, the <code>address</code> element ties the disk
        to a given slot of a controller (the
        actual <code>&lt;controller&gt;</code> device can often be
        inferred by libvirt, although it can
        be <a href="#elementsControllers">explicitly specified</a>).
        The <code>type</code> attribute is mandatory, and is typically
        "pci" or "drive".  For a "pci" controller, additional
        attributes for <code>bus</code>, <code>slot</code>,
2576 2577 2578 2579 2580
        and <code>function</code> must be present, as well as
        optional <code>domain</code> and <code>multifunction</code>.
        Multifunction defaults to 'off'; any other value requires
        QEMU 0.1.3 and <span class="since">libvirt 0.9.7</span>.  For a
        "drive" controller, additional attributes
2581 2582 2583
        <code>controller</code>, <code>bus</code>, <code>target</code>
        (<span class="since">libvirt 0.9.11</span>), and <code>unit</code>
        are available, each defaulting to 0.
2584 2585
      </dd>
      <dt><code>auth</code></dt>
2586 2587 2588 2589
      <dd>The <code>auth</code> element is supported for a disk
        <code>type</code> "network" that is using a <code>source</code>
        element with the <code>protocol</code> attributes "rbd" or "iscsi".
        If present, the <code>auth</code> element provides the
2590 2591 2592 2593 2594 2595 2596 2597
        authentication credentials needed to access the source.  It
        includes a mandatory attribute <code>username</code>, which
        identifies the username to use during authentication, as well
        as a sub-element <code>secret</code> with mandatory
        attribute <code>type</code>, to tie back to
        a <a href="formatsecret.html">libvirt secret object</a> that
        holds the actual password or other credentials (the domain XML
        intentionally does not expose the password, only the reference
2598 2599 2600 2601 2602
        to the object that does manage the password).
        Known secret types are "ceph" for Ceph RBD network sources and
        "iscsi" for CHAP authentication of iSCSI targets.
        Both will require either a <code>uuid</code> attribute
        with the UUID of the secret object or a <code>usage</code>
2603 2604
        attribute matching the key that was specified in the
        secret object.  <span class="since">libvirt 0.9.7</span>
E
Eric Blake 已提交
2605
      </dd>
J
J.B. Joret 已提交
2606 2607 2608 2609 2610 2611 2612 2613 2614 2615 2616 2617 2618 2619 2620 2621 2622 2623 2624
      <dt><code>geometry</code></dt>
      <dd>The optional <code>geometry</code> element provides the
        ability to override geometry settings. This mostly useful for
        S390 DASD-disks or older DOS-disks.  <span class="since">0.10.0</span>
        <dl>
          <dt><code>cyls</code></dt>
          <dd>The <code>cyls</code> attribute is the
            number of cylinders. </dd>
          <dt><code>heads</code></dt>
          <dd>The <code>heads</code> attribute is the
            number of heads. </dd>
          <dt><code>secs</code></dt>
          <dd>The <code>secs</code> attribute is the
            number of sectors per track. </dd>
          <dt><code>trans</code></dt>
          <dd>The optional <code>trans</code> attribute is the
            BIOS-Translation-Modus (none, lba or auto)</dd>
        </dl>
      </dd>
V
Viktor Mihajlovski 已提交
2625 2626
      <dt><code>blockio</code></dt>
      <dd>If present, the <code>blockio</code> element allows
2627 2628 2629 2630 2631 2632 2633 2634
        to override any of the block device properties listed below.
        <span class="since">Since 0.10.2 (QEMU and KVM)</span>
        <dl>
          <dt><code>logical_block_size</code></dt>
          <dd>The logical block size the disk will report to the guest
            OS. For Linux this would be the value returned by the
            BLKSSZGET ioctl and describes the smallest units for disk
            I/O.
2635
          </dd>
2636 2637 2638 2639 2640
          <dt><code>physical_block_size</code></dt>
          <dd>The physical block size the disk will report to the guest
            OS. For Linux this would be the value returned by the
            BLKPBSZGET ioctl and describes the disk's hardware sector
            size which can be relevant for the alignment of disk data.
2641
          </dd>
2642 2643
        </dl>
      </dd>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
2644 2645
    </dl>

2646 2647 2648 2649 2650 2651 2652 2653 2654 2655 2656 2657 2658 2659
    <h4><a name="elementsFilesystems">Filesystems</a></h4>

    <p>
      A directory on the host that can be accessed directly from the guest.
      <span class="since">since 0.3.3, since 0.8.5 for QEMU/KVM</span>
    </p>

<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;filesystem type='template'&gt;
      &lt;source name='my-vm-template'/&gt;
      &lt;target dir='/'/&gt;
    &lt;/filesystem&gt;
2660
    &lt;filesystem type='mount' accessmode='passthrough'&gt;
2661
      &lt;driver type='path' wrpolicy='immediate'/&gt;
2662 2663 2664 2665
      &lt;source dir='/export/to/guest'/&gt;
      &lt;target dir='/import/from/host'/&gt;
      &lt;readonly/&gt;
    &lt;/filesystem&gt;
2666 2667 2668 2669 2670 2671 2672
    &lt;filesystem type='file' accessmode='passthrough'&gt;
      &lt;driver name='loop' type='raw'/&gt;
      &lt;driver type='path' wrpolicy='immediate'/&gt;
      &lt;source file='/export/to/guest.img'/&gt;
      &lt;target dir='/import/from/host'/&gt;
      &lt;readonly/&gt;
    &lt;/filesystem&gt;
2673 2674 2675 2676 2677 2678 2679 2680 2681 2682 2683 2684 2685 2686 2687 2688 2689
    ...
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>

    <dl>
      <dt><code>filesystem</code></dt>
      <dd>

      The filesystem attribute <code>type</code> specifies the type of the
      <code>source</code>. The possible values are:

        <dl>
        <dt><code>type='mount'</code></dt>
        <dd>
        A host directory to mount in the guest. Used by LXC,
        OpenVZ <span class="since">(since 0.6.2)</span>
        and QEMU/KVM <span class="since">(since 0.8.5)</span>.
2690
        This is the default <code>type</code> if one is not specified.
2691 2692 2693 2694
        This mode also has an optional
        sub-element <code>driver</code>, with an
        attribute <code>type='path'</code>
        or <code>type='handle'</code> <span class="since">(since
2695 2696 2697 2698 2699 2700
        0.9.7)</span>. The driver block has an optional attribute
        <code>wrpolicy</code> that further controls interaction with
        the host page cache; omitting the attribute gives default behavior,
        while the value <code>immediate</code> means that a host writeback
        is immediately triggered for all pages touched during a guest file
        write operation <span class="since">(since 0.9.10)</span>.
2701 2702 2703 2704 2705 2706 2707
        </dd>
        <dt><code>type='template'</code></dt>
        <dd>
        OpenVZ filesystem template. Only used by OpenVZ driver.
        </dd>
        <dt><code>type='file'</code></dt>
        <dd>
2708 2709 2710
        A host file will be treated as an image and mounted in
        the guest. The filesystem format will be autodetected.
        Only used by LXC driver.
2711 2712 2713
        </dd>
        <dt><code>type='block'</code></dt>
        <dd>
2714 2715 2716
        A host block device to mount in the guest. The filesystem
        format will be autodetected. Only used by LXC driver
        <span class="since">(since 0.9.5)</span>.
2717
        </dd>
2718 2719 2720 2721
        <dt><code>type='ram'</code></dt>
        <dd>
          An in-memory filesystem, using memory from the host OS.
          The source element has a single attribute <code>usage</code>
2722 2723
          which gives the memory usage limit in KiB, unless units
          are specified by the <code>units</code> attribute. Only used
2724 2725
          by LXC driver.
          <span class="since"> (since 0.9.13)</span></dd>
E
Eric Blake 已提交
2726
        <dt><code>type='bind'</code></dt>
2727 2728 2729 2730
        <dd>
          A directory inside the guest will be bound to another
          directory inside the guest. Only used by LXC driver
          <span class="since"> (since 0.9.13)</span></dd>
2731 2732
        </dl>

2733
      The filesystem block has an optional attribute <code>accessmode</code>
2734 2735 2736 2737 2738 2739
      which specifies the security mode for accessing the source
      <span class="since">(since 0.8.5)</span>. Currently this only works
      with <code>type='mount'</code> for the QEMU/KVM driver. The possible
      values are:

        <dl>
2740
        <dt><code>accessmode='passthrough'</code></dt>
2741 2742
        <dd>
        The <code>source</code> is accessed with the permissions of the
2743
        user inside the guest. This is the default <code>accessmode</code> if
2744 2745 2746
        one is not specified.
        <a href="http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/qemu-devel/2010-05/msg02673.html">More info</a>
        </dd>
2747
        <dt><code>accessmode='mapped'</code></dt>
2748 2749 2750 2751 2752
        <dd>
        The <code>source</code> is accessed with the permissions of the
        hypervisor (QEMU process).
        <a href="http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/qemu-devel/2010-05/msg02673.html">More info</a>
        </dd>
2753
        <dt><code>accessmode='squash'</code></dt>
2754 2755 2756 2757 2758 2759 2760 2761 2762 2763 2764
        <dd>
        Similar to 'passthrough', the exception is that failure of
        privileged operations like 'chown' are ignored. This makes a
        passthrough-like mode usable for people who run the hypervisor
        as non-root.
        <a href="http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/qemu-devel/2010-09/msg00121.html">More info</a>
        </dd>
        </dl>

      </dd>

2765 2766 2767 2768 2769 2770 2771 2772 2773 2774 2775
      <dt><code>driver</code></dt>
      <dd>
        The optional driver element allows specifying further details
        related to the hypervisor driver used to provide the filesystem.
        <span class="since">Since 1.0.6</span>
        <ul>
          <li>
            If the hypervisor supports multiple backend drivers, then
            the <code>type</code> attribute selects the primary
            backend driver name, while the <code>format</code>
            attribute provides the format type. For example, LXC
2776 2777
            supports a type of "loop", with a format of "raw" or
            "nbd" with any format. QEMU supports a type of "path"
2778
            or "handle", but no formats. Virtuozzo driver supports
D
Dmitry Guryanov 已提交
2779
            a type of "ploop" with a format of "ploop".
2780 2781 2782 2783
          </li>
        </ul>
      </dd>

2784 2785 2786 2787 2788
      <dt><code>source</code></dt>
      <dd>
        The resource on the host that is being accessed in the guest. The
        <code>name</code> attribute must be used with
        <code>type='template'</code>, and the <code>dir</code> attribute must
2789
        be used with <code>type='mount'</code>. The <code>usage</code> attribute
2790 2791
        is used with <code>type='ram'</code> to set the memory limit in KiB,
        unless units are specified by the <code>units</code> attribute.
2792 2793 2794 2795 2796 2797 2798 2799 2800 2801 2802 2803
      </dd>

      <dt><code>target</code></dt>
      <dd>
        Where the <code>source</code> can be accessed in the guest. For
        most drivers this is an automatic mount point, but for QEMU/KVM
        this is merely an arbitrary string tag that is exported to the
        guest as a hint for where to mount.
      </dd>

      <dt><code>readonly</code></dt>
      <dd>
2804
        Enables exporting filesystem as a readonly mount for guest, by
2805 2806
        default read-write access is given (currently only works for
        QEMU/KVM driver).
2807
      </dd>
2808 2809 2810 2811 2812 2813 2814 2815 2816 2817 2818 2819 2820 2821

      <dt><code>space_hard_limit</code></dt>
      <dd>
        Maximum space available to this guest's filesystem.
        <span class="since">Since 0.9.13</span>
      </dd>

      <dt><code>space_soft_limit</code></dt>
      <dd>
        Maximum space available to this guest's filesystem. The container is
        permitted to exceed its soft limits for a grace period of time. Afterwards the
        hard limit is enforced.
        <span class="since">Since 0.9.13</span>
      </dd>
2822 2823
    </dl>

2824 2825 2826 2827 2828 2829 2830 2831 2832 2833 2834 2835 2836 2837 2838 2839 2840 2841 2842
    <h4><a name="elementsAddress">Device Addresses</a></h4>

    <p>
      Many devices have an optional <code>&lt;address&gt;</code>
      sub-element to describe where the device is placed on the
      virtual bus presented to the guest.  If an address (or any
      optional attribute within an address) is omitted on
      input, libvirt will generate an appropriate address; but an
      explicit address is required if more control over layout is
      required.  See below for device examples including an address
      element.
    </p>

    <p>
      Every address has a mandatory attribute <code>type</code> that
      describes which bus the device is on.  The choice of which
      address to use for a given device is constrained in part by the
      device and the architecture of the guest.  For example,
      a <code>&lt;disk&gt;</code> device
2843
      uses <code>type='drive'</code>, while
2844 2845 2846 2847 2848 2849 2850 2851 2852 2853 2854 2855 2856 2857 2858 2859 2860 2861 2862 2863 2864 2865 2866 2867 2868 2869 2870
      a <code>&lt;console&gt;</code> device would
      use <code>type='pci'</code> on i686 or x86_64 guests,
      or <code>type='spapr-vio'</code> on PowerPC64 pseries guests.
      Each address type has further optional attributes that control
      where on the bus the device will be placed:
    </p>

    <dl>
      <dt><code>type='pci'</code></dt>
      <dd>PCI addresses have the following additional
        attributes: <code>domain</code> (a 2-byte hex integer, not
        currently used by qemu), <code>bus</code> (a hex value between
        0 and 0xff, inclusive), <code>slot</code> (a hex value between
        0x0 and 0x1f, inclusive), and <code>function</code> (a value
        between 0 and 7, inclusive).  Also available is
        the <code>multifunction</code> attribute, which controls
        turning on the multifunction bit for a particular
        slot/function in the PCI control register
        (<span class="since">since 0.9.7, requires QEMU
        0.13</span>). <code>multifunction</code> defaults to 'off',
        but should be set to 'on' for function 0 of a slot that will
        have multiple functions used.
      </dd>
      <dt><code>type='drive'</code></dt>
      <dd>Drive addresses have the following additional
        attributes: <code>controller</code> (a 2-digit controller
        number), <code>bus</code> (a 2-digit bus number),
2871
        <code>target</code> (a 2-digit target number),
2872 2873 2874 2875 2876 2877 2878 2879 2880 2881 2882 2883 2884
        and <code>unit</code> (a 2-digit unit number on the bus).
      </dd>
      <dt><code>type='virtio-serial'</code></dt>
      <dd>Each virtio-serial address has the following additional
        attributes: <code>controller</code> (a 2-digit controller
        number), <code>bus</code> (a 2-digit bus number),
        and <code>slot</code> (a 2-digit slot within the bus).
      </dd>
      <dt><code>type='ccid'</code></dt>
      <dd>A CCID address, for smart-cards, has the following
        additional attributes: <code>bus</code> (a 2-digit bus
        number), and <code>slot</code> attribute (a 2-digit slot
        within the bus).  <span class="since">Since 0.8.8.</span>
2885
      </dd>
2886 2887 2888 2889 2890 2891 2892 2893 2894 2895 2896 2897 2898 2899 2900
      <dt><code>type='usb'</code></dt>
      <dd>USB addresses have the following additional
        attributes: <code>bus</code> (a hex value between 0 and 0xfff,
        inclusive), and <code>port</code> (a dotted notation of up to
        four octets, such as 1.2 or 2.1.3.1).
      </dd>
      <dt><code>type='spapr-vio'</code></dt>
      <dd>On PowerPC pseries guests, devices can be assigned to the
        SPAPR-VIO bus.  It has a flat 64-bit address space; by
        convention, devices are generally assigned at a non-zero
        multiple of 0x1000, but other addresses are valid and
        permitted by libvirt.  Each address has the following
        additional attribute: <code>reg</code> (the hex value address
        of the starting register).  <span class="since">Since
        0.9.9.</span>
2901 2902 2903 2904 2905 2906 2907 2908 2909 2910
      </dd>
      <dt><code>type='ccw'</code></dt>
      <dd>s390 guests with a <code>machine</code> value of
        s390-ccw-virtio use the native CCW bus for I/O devices.
        CCW bus addresses have the following additional attributes:
        <code>cssid</code> (a hex value between 0 and 0xfe, inclusive),
        <code>ssid</code> (a value between 0 and 3, inclusive) and
        <code>devno</code> (a hex value between 0 and 0xffff, inclusive).
        Partially specified bus addresses are not allowed.
        If omitted, libvirt will assign a free bus address with
2911 2912
        cssid=0xfe and ssid=0. Virtio-ccw devices must have their cssid
        set to 0xfe.
2913
        <span class="since">Since 1.0.4</span>
2914
      </dd>
H
Hu Tao 已提交
2915 2916 2917 2918 2919
      <dt><code>type='isa'</code></dt>
      <dd>ISA addresses have the following additional
        attributes: <code>iobase</code> and <code>irq</code>.
        <span class="since">Since 1.2.1</span>
      </dd>
2920 2921
    </dl>

E
Eric Blake 已提交
2922 2923 2924
    <h4><a name="elementsControllers">Controllers</a></h4>

    <p>
2925
      Depending on the guest architecture, some device buses can
2926 2927
      appear more than once, with a group of virtual devices tied to a
      virtual controller.  Normally, libvirt can automatically infer such
E
Eric Blake 已提交
2928 2929 2930 2931 2932 2933 2934 2935 2936 2937 2938 2939 2940 2941 2942 2943 2944 2945
      controllers without requiring explicit XML markup, but sometimes
      it is necessary to provide an explicit controller element.
    </p>

<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;controller type='ide' index='0'/&gt;
    &lt;controller type='virtio-serial' index='0' ports='16' vectors='4'/&gt;
    &lt;controller type='virtio-serial' index='1'&gt;
      &lt;address type='pci' domain='0x0000' bus='0x00' slot='0x0a' function='0x0'/&gt;
    &lt;/controller&gt;
    ...
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>

    <p>
      Each controller has a mandatory attribute <code>type</code>,
2946
      which must be one of "ide", "fdc", "scsi", "sata", "usb",
J
Ján Tomko 已提交
2947
      "ccid", "virtio-serial" or "pci", and a mandatory
2948 2949 2950 2951 2952
      attribute <code>index</code> which is the decimal integer
      describing in which order the bus controller is encountered (for
      use in <code>controller</code> attributes
      of <code>&lt;address&gt;</code> elements).  The "virtio-serial"
      controller has two additional optional
E
Eric Blake 已提交
2953 2954 2955
      attributes <code>ports</code> and <code>vectors</code>, which
      control how many devices can be connected through the
      controller.  A "scsi" controller has an optional
2956
      attribute <code>model</code>, which is one of "auto", "buslogic",
2957
      "ibmvscsi", "lsilogic", "lsisas1068", "lsisas1078", "virtio-scsi" or
2958 2959 2960 2961 2962 2963
      "vmpvscsi".  A "usb" controller has an optional attribute
      <code>model</code>, which is one of "piix3-uhci", "piix4-uhci", "ehci",
      "ich9-ehci1", "ich9-uhci1", "ich9-uhci2", "ich9-uhci3", "vt82c686b-uhci",
      "pci-ohci" or "nec-xhci".  Additionally,
      <span class="since">since 0.10.0</span>, if the USB bus needs to be
      explicitly disabled for the guest, <code>model='none'</code> may be
2964 2965 2966
      used.  <span class="since">Since 1.0.5</span>, no default USB controller
      will be built on s390.  The PowerPC64 "spapr-vio" addresses do not have an
      associated controller.
E
Eric Blake 已提交
2967 2968 2969 2970 2971 2972
    </p>

    <p>
      For controllers that are themselves devices on a PCI or USB bus,
      an optional sub-element <code>&lt;address&gt;</code> can specify
      the exact relationship of the controller to its master bus, with
2973
      semantics <a href="#elementsAddress">given above</a>.
E
Eric Blake 已提交
2974 2975
    </p>

2976 2977
    <p>
      An optional sub-element <code>driver</code> can specify the driver
2978
      specific options:
2979
    </p>
2980 2981 2982 2983 2984 2985 2986 2987 2988 2989 2990 2991 2992 2993 2994 2995 2996 2997 2998 2999 3000 3001 3002
    <dl>
      <dt><code>queues</code></dt>
      <dd>
        The optional <code>queues</code> attribute specifies the number of
        queues for the controller. For best performance, it's recommended to
        specify a value matching the number of vCPUs.
        <span class="since">Since 1.0.5 (QEMU and KVM only)</span>
      </dd>
      <dt><code>cmd_per_lun</code></dt>
      <dd>
        The optional <code>cmd_per_lun</code> attribute specifies the maximum
        number of commands that can be queued on devices controlled by the
        host.
        <span class="since">Since 1.2.7 (QEMU and KVM only)</span>
      </dd>
      <dt><code>max_sectors</code></dt>
      <dd>
        The optional <code>max_sectors</code> attribute specifies the maximum
        amount of data in bytes that will be transferred to or from the device
        in a single command. The transfer length is measured in sectors, where
        a sector is 512 bytes.
        <span class="since">Since 1.2.7 (QEMU and KVM only)</span>
      </dd>
3003 3004 3005 3006 3007 3008 3009 3010
      <dt><code>ioeventfd</code></dt>
      <dd>
        The optional <code>ioeventfd</code> attribute specifies
        whether the controller should use
        <a href='https://patchwork.kernel.org/patch/43390/'>
        I/O asynchronous handling</a> or not.  Accepted values are
        "on" and "off". <span class="since">Since 1.2.18</span>
      </dd>
3011
    </dl>
3012 3013 3014 3015 3016 3017
    <p>
      USB companion controllers have an optional
      sub-element <code>&lt;master&gt;</code> to specify the exact
      relationship of the companion to its master controller.
      A companion controller is on the same bus as its master, so
      the companion <code>index</code> value should be equal.
3018 3019 3020 3021 3022
      Not all controller models can be used as companion controllers
      and libvirt might provide some sensible defaults (settings
      of <code>master startport</code> and <code>function</code> of an
      address) for some particular models.
      Preferred companion controllers are <code>ich-uhci[123]</code>.
3023 3024 3025 3026 3027 3028 3029 3030 3031 3032
    </p>

<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;controller type='usb' index='0' model='ich9-ehci1'&gt;
      &lt;address type='pci' domain='0' bus='0' slot='4' function='7'/&gt;
    &lt;/controller&gt;
    &lt;controller type='usb' index='0' model='ich9-uhci1'&gt;
      &lt;master startport='0'/&gt;
3033
      &lt;address type='pci' domain='0' bus='0' slot='4' function='0' multifunction='on'/&gt;
3034 3035 3036
    &lt;/controller&gt;
    ...
  &lt;/devices&gt;
J
Ján Tomko 已提交
3037 3038 3039 3040
  ...</pre>

    <p>
      PCI controllers have an optional <code>model</code> attribute with
3041
      possible values <code>pci-root</code>, <code>pcie-root</code>,
3042
      <code>pcie-root-port</code>, <code>pci-bridge</code>,
3043 3044
      <code>dmi-to-pci-bridge</code>, <code>pcie-switch-upstream-port</code>, or
      <code>pcie-switch-downstream-port</code>.
3045 3046
      (pci-root and pci-bridge <span class="since">since 1.0.5</span>,
      pcie-root and dmi-to-pci-bridge <span class="since">since
3047 3048
      1.1.2</span>, pcie-root-port, pcie-switch-upstream-port, and
      pcie-switch-downstream-port <span class="since">since 1.2.19</span>)
3049 3050 3051 3052 3053 3054 3055 3056
      The root controllers (<code>pci-root</code> and <code>pcie-root</code>)
      have an optional <code>pcihole64</code> element specifying how big
      (in kilobytes, or in the unit specified by <code>pcihole64</code>'s
      <code>unit</code> attribute) the 64-bit PCI hole should be. Some guests (like
      Windows XP or Windows Server 2003) might crash when QEMU and Seabios
      are recent enough to support 64-bit PCI holes, unless this is disabled
      (set to 0). <span class="since">Since 1.1.2 (QEMU only)</span>
    </p>
3057 3058 3059 3060 3061 3062 3063 3064 3065 3066 3067 3068 3069
    <p>
      PCI controllers also have an optional
      subelement <code>&lt;model&gt;</code> with an attribute
      <code>name</code>. The name attribute holds the name of the
      specific device that qemu is emulating (e.g. "i82801b11-bridge")
      rather than simply the class of device ("dmi-to-pci-bridge",
      "pci-bridge"), which is set in the controller element's
      model <b>attribute</b>.  In almost all cases, you should not
      manually add a <code>&lt;model&gt;</code> subelement to a
      controller, nor should you modify one that is automatically
      generated by libvirt. <span class="since">Since 1.2.19 (QEMU
      only).</span>
    </p>
3070 3071 3072 3073 3074 3075 3076 3077 3078 3079 3080 3081 3082 3083 3084 3085 3086 3087 3088 3089 3090 3091 3092
    <p>
      PCI controllers also have an optional
      subelement <code>&lt;target&gt;</code> with the attributes
      listed below. These are configurable items that 1) are visible
      to the guest OS so must be preserved for guest ABI
      compatibility, and 2) are usually left to default values or
      derived automatically by libvirt. In almost all cases, you
      should not manually add a <code>&lt;target&gt;</code> subelement
      to a controller, nor should you modify the values in the those
      that are automatically generated by
      libvirt. <span class="since">Since 1.2.19 (QEMU only).</span>
    </p>
    <dl>
      <dt><code>chassisNr</code></dt>
      <dd>
        PCI controllers that have attribute model="pci-bridge", can
        also have a <code>chassisNr</code> attribute in
        the <code>&lt;target&gt;</code> subelement, which is used to
        control QEMU's "chassis_nr" option for the pci-bridge device
        (normally libvirt automatically sets this to the same value as
        the index attribute of the pci controller). If set, chassisNr
        must be between 0 and 255.
      </dd>
3093 3094
      <dt><code>chassis</code></dt>
      <dd>
3095 3096
        pcie-root-port and pcie-switch-downstream-port controllers can
        also have a <code>chassis</code> attribute in
3097 3098 3099 3100 3101 3102 3103
        the <code>&lt;target&gt;</code> subelement, which is used to
        set the controller's "chassis" configuration value, which is
        visible to the virtual machine. If set, chassis must be
        between 0 and 255.
      </dd>
      <dt><code>port</code></dt>
      <dd>
3104 3105 3106
        pcie-root-port and pcie-switch-downstream-port controllers can
        also have a <code>port</code> attribute in
        the <code>&lt;target&gt;</code> subelement, which
3107 3108 3109 3110
        is used to set the controller's "port" configuration value,
        which is visible to the virtual machine. If set, port must be
        between 0 and 255.
      </dd>
3111
    </dl>
3112
    <p>
L
Laine Stump 已提交
3113
      For machine types which provide an implicit PCI bus, the pci-root
J
Ján Tomko 已提交
3114
      controller with index=0 is auto-added and required to use PCI devices.
L
Laine Stump 已提交
3115
      pci-root has no address.
3116 3117 3118
      PCI bridges are auto-added if there are too many devices to fit on
      the one bus provided by pci-root, or a PCI bus number greater than zero
      was specified.
J
Ján Tomko 已提交
3119 3120 3121 3122 3123 3124 3125 3126 3127 3128
      PCI bridges can also be specified manually, but their addresses should
      only refer to PCI buses provided by already specified PCI controllers.
      Leaving gaps in the PCI controller indexes might lead to an invalid
      configuration.
    </p>
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;controller type='pci' index='0' model='pci-root'/&gt;
    &lt;controller type='pci' index='1' model='pci-bridge'&gt;
L
Laine Stump 已提交
3129
      &lt;address type='pci' domain='0' bus='0' slot='5' function='0' multifunction='off'/&gt;
J
Ján Tomko 已提交
3130 3131
    &lt;/controller&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
L
Laine Stump 已提交
3132 3133 3134 3135 3136 3137 3138
  ...</pre>

    <p>
      For machine types which provide an implicit PCI Express (PCIe)
      bus (for example, the machine types based on the Q35 chipset),
      the pcie-root controller with index=0 is auto-added to the
      domain's configuration. pcie-root has also no address, provides
3139 3140 3141 3142 3143 3144
      31 slots (numbered 1-31) that can be used to attach PCIe or PCI
      devices (although libvirt will never auto-assign a PCI device to
      a PCIe slot, it will allow manual specification of such an
      assignment). Devices connected to pcie-root cannot be
      hotplugged. In order to make standard PCI slots available on a
      system which has a pcie-root controller, a pci controller
3145
      with <code>model='dmi-to-pci-bridge'</code> is automatically
3146 3147 3148 3149
      added, usually at the defacto standard location of slot=0x1e. A
      dmi-to-pci-bridge controller plugs into a PCIe slot (as provided
      by pcie-root), and itself provides 31 standard PCI slots (which
      also do not support device hotplug). In order to have
3150 3151 3152
      hot-pluggable PCI slots in the guest system, a pci-bridge
      controller will also be automatically created and connected to
      one of the slots of the auto-created dmi-to-pci-bridge
3153
      controller; all guest PCI devices with addresses that are
3154 3155
      auto-determined by libvirt will be placed on this pci-bridge
      device.  (<span class="since">since 1.1.2</span>).
L
Laine Stump 已提交
3156
    </p>
3157 3158
    <p>
      Domains with an implicit pcie-root can also add controllers
3159 3160 3161 3162 3163 3164 3165 3166 3167 3168 3169 3170 3171 3172 3173 3174 3175 3176 3177 3178 3179 3180 3181 3182 3183 3184
      with <code>model='pcie-root-port'</code>,
      <code>model='pcie-switch-upstream-port'</code>,
      and <code>model='pcie-switch-downstream-port'</code>. pcie-root-port
      is a simple type of bridge device that can connect only to one
      of the 31 slots on the pcie-root bus on its upstream side, and
      makes a single (PCIe, hotpluggable) port available on the
      downstream side (at slot='0'). pcie-root-port can be used to
      provide a single slot to later hotplug a PCIe device (but is not
      itself hotpluggable - it must be in the configuration when the
      domain is started).
      (<span class="since">since 1.2.19</span>)
    </p>
    <p>
      pcie-switch-upstream-port is a more flexible (but also more
      complex) device that can only plug into a pcie-root-port or
      pcie-switch-downstream-port on the upstream side (and only
      before the domain is started - it is not hot-pluggable), and
      provides 32 ports on the downstream side (slot='0' - slot='31')
      that accept only pcie-switch-downstream-port devices; each
      pcie-switch-downstream-port device can only plug into a
      pcie-switch-upstream-port on its upstream side (again, not
      hot-pluggable), and on its downstream side provides a single
      hotpluggable pcie port that can accept any standard pci or pcie
      device (or another pcie-switch-upstream-port), i.e. identical in
      function to a pcie-root-port.  (<span class="since">since
      1.2.19</span>)
3185
    </p>
L
Laine Stump 已提交
3186 3187 3188 3189
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;controller type='pci' index='0' model='pcie-root'/&gt;
3190 3191 3192 3193 3194 3195
    &lt;controller type='pci' index='1' model='dmi-to-pci-bridge'&gt;
      &lt;address type='pci' domain='0' bus='0' slot='0xe' function='0'/&gt;
    &lt;/controller&gt;
    &lt;controller type='pci' index='2' model='pci-bridge'&gt;
      &lt;address type='pci' domain='0' bus='1' slot='1' function='0'/&gt;
    &lt;/controller&gt;
L
Laine Stump 已提交
3196
  &lt;/devices&gt;
3197 3198
  ...</pre>

3199 3200 3201 3202 3203 3204 3205 3206 3207 3208 3209 3210 3211 3212 3213 3214 3215 3216 3217 3218 3219 3220 3221 3222 3223 3224 3225 3226 3227 3228 3229 3230 3231 3232 3233 3234 3235 3236 3237
    <h4><a name="elementsLease">Device leases</a></h4>

    <p>
      When using a lock manager, it may be desirable to record device leases
      against a VM. The lock manager will ensure the VM won't start unless
      the leases can be acquired.
    </p>

<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    ...
    &lt;lease&gt;
      &lt;lockspace&gt;somearea&lt;/lockspace&gt;
      &lt;key&gt;somekey&lt;/key&gt;
      &lt;target path='/some/lease/path' offset='1024'/&gt;
    &lt;/lease&gt;
    ...
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>

    <dl>
      <dt>lockspace</dt>
      <dd>This is an arbitrary string, identifying the lockspace
        within which the key is held. Lock managers may impose
        extra restrictions on the format, or length of the lockspace
        name.</dd>
      <dt>key</dt>
      <dd>This is an arbitrary string, uniquely identifying the
        lease to be acquired. Lock managers may impose extra
        restrictions on the format, or length of the key.
      </dd>
      <dt>target</dt>
      <dd>This is the fully qualified path of the file associated
        with the lockspace. The offset specifies where the lease
        is stored within the file. If the lock manager does not
        require a offset, just pass 0.
      </dd>
    </dl>
E
Eric Blake 已提交
3238

3239 3240
    <h4><a name="elementsHostDev">Host device assignment</a></h4>

3241
    <h5><a name="elementsHostDevSubsys">USB / PCI / SCSI devices</a></h5>
3242 3243

    <p>
H
Han Cheng 已提交
3244
      USB, PCI and SCSI devices attached to the host can be passed through
3245
      to the guest using the <code>hostdev</code> element.
H
Han Cheng 已提交
3246 3247
      <span class="since">since after 0.4.4 for USB, 0.6.0 for PCI(KVM only)
        and 1.0.6 for SCSI(KVM only)</span>:
3248 3249
    </p>

3250 3251 3252 3253
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;hostdev mode='subsystem' type='usb'&gt;
3254
      &lt;source startupPolicy='optional'&gt;
3255 3256 3257
        &lt;vendor id='0x1234'/&gt;
        &lt;product id='0xbeef'/&gt;
      &lt;/source&gt;
3258
      &lt;boot order='2'/&gt;
3259 3260 3261 3262
    &lt;/hostdev&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>

3263
    <p>or:</p>
3264 3265 3266 3267

<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
3268
    &lt;hostdev mode='subsystem' type='pci' managed='yes'&gt;
3269
      &lt;source&gt;
3270
        &lt;address domain='0x0000' bus='0x06' slot='0x02' function='0x0'/&gt;
3271
      &lt;/source&gt;
3272
      &lt;boot order='1'/&gt;
3273
      &lt;rom bar='on' file='/etc/fake/boot.bin'/&gt;
3274 3275
    &lt;/hostdev&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
H
Han Cheng 已提交
3276 3277 3278 3279 3280 3281 3282
  ...</pre>

    <p>or:</p>

<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
3283
    &lt;hostdev mode='subsystem' type='scsi' sgio='filtered' rawio='yes'&gt;
H
Han Cheng 已提交
3284 3285
      &lt;source&gt;
        &lt;adapter name='scsi_host0'/&gt;
3286
        &lt;address bus='0' target='0' unit='0'/&gt;
H
Han Cheng 已提交
3287 3288 3289 3290 3291
      &lt;/source&gt;
      &lt;readonly/&gt;
      &lt;address type='drive' controller='0' bus='0' target='0' unit='0'/&gt;
    &lt;/hostdev&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
3292
  ...</pre>
3293

J
John Ferlan 已提交
3294 3295 3296 3297 3298 3299 3300 3301 3302 3303 3304 3305 3306 3307 3308 3309 3310 3311

    <p>or:</p>

<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;hostdev mode='subsystem' type='scsi'&gt;
      &lt;source protocol='iscsi' name='iqn.2014-08.com.example:iscsi-nopool/1'&gt;
        &lt;host name='example.com' port='3260'/&gt;
        &lt;auth username='myuser'&gt;
          &lt;secret type='iscsi' usage='libvirtiscsi'/&gt;
        &lt;/auth&gt;
      &lt;/source&gt;
      &lt;address type='drive' controller='0' bus='0' target='0' unit='0'/&gt;
    &lt;/hostdev&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>

3312 3313 3314
    <dl>
      <dt><code>hostdev</code></dt>
      <dd>The <code>hostdev</code> element is the main container for describing
J
John Ferlan 已提交
3315 3316 3317 3318 3319
        host devices. For each device, the <code>mode</code> is always
        "subsystem" and the <code>type</code> is one of the following values
        with additional attributes noted.
        <dl>
          <dt>usb</dt>
3320 3321 3322
          <dd>USB devices are detached from the host on guest startup
            and reattached after the guest exits or the device is
            hot-unplugged.
J
John Ferlan 已提交
3323 3324 3325 3326 3327
          </dd>
          <dt>pci</dt>
          <dd>For PCI devices, when <code>managed</code> is "yes" it is
            detached from the host before being passed on to the guest
            and reattached to the host after the guest exits. If
3328 3329 3330 3331 3332 3333
            <code>managed</code> is omitted or "no", the user is
            responsible to call <code>virNodeDeviceDetachFlags</code>
            (or <code>virsh nodedev-detach</code> before starting the guest
            or hot-plugging the device and <code>virNodeDeviceReAttach</code>
            (or <code>virsh nodedev-reattach</code>) after hot-unplug or
            stopping the guest.
J
John Ferlan 已提交
3334 3335 3336
          </dd>
          <dt>scsi</dt>
          <dd>For SCSI devices, user is responsible to make sure the device
3337 3338 3339 3340 3341 3342
            is not used by host. If supported by the hypervisor and OS, the
            optional <code>sgio</code> (<span class="since">since 1.0.6</span>)
            attribute indicates whether unprivileged SG_IO commands are
            filtered for the disk. Valid settings are "filtered" or
            "unfiltered", where the default is "filtered".
            The optional <code>rawio</code>
3343 3344 3345 3346 3347 3348
            (<span class="since">since 1.2.9</span>) attribute indicates
            whether the lun needs the rawio capability. Valid settings are
            "yes" or "no". See the rawio description within the
            <a href="#elementsDisks">disk</a> section.
            If a disk lun in the domain already has the rawio capability,
            then this setting not required.
J
John Ferlan 已提交
3349 3350
          </dd>
        </dl>
3351 3352 3353 3354 3355 3356
        <p>
          Note: The <code>managed</code> attribute is only used with PCI devices
          and is ignored by all the other device types, thus setting
          <code>managed</code> explicitly with other than PCI device has the same
          effect as omitting it.
        </p>
O
Osier Yang 已提交
3357
      </dd>
3358
      <dt><code>source</code></dt>
J
John Ferlan 已提交
3359 3360 3361 3362 3363 3364 3365 3366 3367 3368 3369 3370 3371 3372 3373 3374 3375 3376 3377 3378 3379 3380 3381 3382 3383 3384 3385 3386 3387 3388 3389 3390 3391 3392 3393 3394
      <dd>The source element describes the device as seen from the host using
        the following mechanism to describe:
        <dl>
          <dt>usb</dt>
          <dd>The USB device can either be addressed by vendor / product id
            using the <code>vendor</code> and <code>product</code> elements
            or by the device's address on the host using the
            <code>address</code> element.
            <p>
            <span class="since">Since 1.0.0</span>, the <code>source</code>
            element of USB devices may contain <code>startupPolicy</code>
            attribute which can be used to define policy what to do if the
            specified host USB device is not found. The attribute accepts
            the following values:
            </p>
            <table class="top_table">
              <tr>
                <td> mandatory </td>
                <td> fail if missing for any reason (the default) </td>
              </tr>
              <tr>
                <td> requisite </td>
                <td> fail if missing on boot up,
                     drop if missing on migrate/restore/revert </td>
              </tr>
              <tr>
                <td> optional </td>
                <td> drop if missing at any start attempt </td>
              </tr>
            </table>
          </dd>
          <dt>pci</dt>
          <dd>PCI devices can only be described by their <code>address</code>.
          </dd>
          <dt>scsi</dt>
          <dd>SCSI devices are described by both the <code>adapter</code>
3395 3396 3397 3398 3399 3400 3401 3402
            and <code>address</code> elements. The <code>address</code>
            element includes a <code>bus</code> attribute (a 2-digit bus
            number), a <code>target</code> attribute (a 10-digit target
            number), and a <code>unit</code> attribute (a 20-digit unit
            number on the bus). Not all hypervisors support larger
            <code>target</code> and <code>unit</code> values. It is up
            to each hypervisor to determine the maximum value supported
            for the adapter.
J
John Ferlan 已提交
3403 3404 3405 3406 3407 3408 3409 3410 3411 3412 3413
            <p>
            <span class="since">Since 1.2.8</span>, the <code>source</code>
            element of a SCSI device may contain the <code>protocol</code>
            attribute. When the attribute is set to "iscsi", the host
            device XML follows the network <a href="#elementsDisks">disk</a>
            device using the same <code>name</code> attribute and optionally
            using the <code>auth</code> element to provide the authentication
            credentials to the iSCSI server.
            </p>
          </dd>
        </dl>
3414
      </dd>
3415 3416 3417 3418 3419
      <dt><code>vendor</code>, <code>product</code></dt>
      <dd>The <code>vendor</code> and <code>product</code> elements each have an
      <code>id</code> attribute that specifies the USB vendor and product id.
      The ids can be given in decimal, hexadecimal (starting with 0x) or
      octal (starting with 0) form.</dd>
3420 3421 3422 3423 3424 3425
      <dt><code>boot</code></dt>
      <dd>Specifies that the device is bootable. The <code>order</code>
      attribute determines the order in which devices will be tried during
      boot sequence. The per-device <code>boot</code> elements cannot be
      used together with general boot elements in
      <a href="#elementsOSBIOS">BIOS bootloader</a> section.
3426 3427
      <span class="since">Since 0.8.8</span> for PCI devices,
      <span class="since">Since 1.0.1</span> for USB devices.
3428
      </dd>
3429 3430
      <dt><code>rom</code></dt>
      <dd>The <code>rom</code> element is used to change how a PCI
3431
        device's ROM is presented to the guest. The optional <code>bar</code>
3432 3433 3434 3435 3436 3437 3438
        attribute can be set to "on" or "off", and determines whether
        or not the device's ROM will be visible in the guest's memory
        map. (In PCI documentation, the "rombar" setting controls the
        presence of the Base Address Register for the ROM). If no rom
        bar is specified, the qemu default will be used (older
        versions of qemu used a default of "off", while newer qemus
        have a default of "on"). <span class="since">Since
3439
        0.9.7 (QEMU and KVM only)</span>. The optional
3440
        <code>file</code> attribute contains an absolute path to a binary file
3441 3442 3443 3444 3445
        to be presented to the guest as the device's ROM BIOS. This
        can be useful, for example, to provide a PXE boot ROM for a
        virtual function of an sr-iov capable ethernet device (which
        has no boot ROMs for the VFs).
        <span class="since">Since 0.9.10 (QEMU and KVM only)</span>.
3446
      </dd>
3447
      <dt><code>address</code></dt>
3448 3449 3450 3451 3452
      <dd>The <code>address</code> element for USB devices has a
      <code>bus</code> and <code>device</code> attribute to specify the
      USB bus and device number the device appears at on the host.
      The values of these attributes can be given in decimal, hexadecimal
      (starting with 0x) or octal (starting with 0) form.
3453
      For PCI devices the element carries 4 attributes allowing to designate
3454
      the device as can be found with the <code>lspci</code> or
3455 3456
      with <code>virsh nodedev-list</code>. For SCSI devices a 'drive'
      address type must be used. <a href="#elementsAddress">See above</a> for
3457 3458 3459 3460 3461 3462 3463 3464
      more details on the address element.</dd>
      <dt><code>driver</code></dt>
      <dd>
        PCI devices can have an optional <code>driver</code>
        subelement that specifies which backend driver to use for PCI
        device assignment. Use the <code>name</code> attribute to
        select either "vfio" (for the new VFIO device assignment
        backend, which is compatible with UEFI SecureBoot) or "kvm"
3465
        (the legacy device assignment handled directly by the KVM
3466
        kernel module)<span class="since">Since 1.0.5 (QEMU and KVM
3467 3468 3469 3470 3471 3472 3473 3474
        only, requires kernel 3.6 or newer)</span>. When specified,
        device assignment will fail if the requested method of device
        assignment isn't available on the host. When not specified,
        the default is "vfio" on systems where the VFIO driver is
        available and loaded, and "kvm" on older systems, or those
        where the VFIO driver hasn't been
        loaded <span class="since">Since 1.1.3</span> (prior to that
        the default was always "kvm").
3475
      </dd>
O
Osier Yang 已提交
3476 3477 3478 3479
      <dt><code>readonly</code></dt>
      <dd>Indicates that the device is readonly, only supported by SCSI host
        device now. <span class="since">Since 1.0.6 (QEMU and KVM only)</span>
      </dd>
3480 3481 3482 3483 3484
      <dt><code>shareable</code></dt>
      <dd>If present, this indicates the device is expected to be shared
        between domains (assuming the hypervisor and OS support this).
        Only supported by SCSI host device.
        <span class="since">Since 1.0.6</span>
3485 3486 3487 3488 3489
        <p>
          Note: Although <code>shareable</code> was introduced
          <span class="since">in 1.0.6</span>, it did not work as
          as expected until <span class="since">1.2.2</span>.
        </p>
3490
      </dd>
3491 3492
    </dl>

3493

3494
    <h5><a name="elementsHostDevCaps">Block / character devices</a></h5>
3495 3496 3497 3498

    <p>
      Block / character devices from the host can be passed through
      to the guest using the <code>hostdev</code> element. This is
3499 3500
      only possible with container based virtualization. Devices are specified
      by a fully qualified path.
3501 3502 3503 3504 3505 3506 3507 3508 3509 3510 3511 3512 3513 3514 3515 3516 3517 3518 3519 3520
      <span class="since">since after 1.0.1 for LXC</span>:
    </p>

    <pre>
...
&lt;hostdev mode='capabilities' type='storage'&gt;
  &lt;source&gt;
    &lt;block&gt;/dev/sdf1&lt;/block&gt;
  &lt;/source&gt;
&lt;/hostdev&gt;
...
    </pre>

    <pre>
...
&lt;hostdev mode='capabilities' type='misc'&gt;
  &lt;source&gt;
    &lt;char&gt;/dev/input/event3&lt;/char&gt;
  &lt;/source&gt;
&lt;/hostdev&gt;
3521 3522 3523
...
    </pre>

O
Osier Yang 已提交
3524
    <pre>
3525 3526 3527 3528 3529 3530
...
&lt;hostdev mode='capabilities' type='net'&gt;
  &lt;source&gt;
    &lt;interface&gt;eth0&lt;/interface&gt;
  &lt;/source&gt;
&lt;/hostdev&gt;
3531 3532 3533 3534 3535 3536 3537
...
    </pre>

    <dl>
      <dt><code>hostdev</code></dt>
      <dd>The <code>hostdev</code> element is the main container for describing
        host devices. For block/character device passthrough <code>mode</code> is
3538 3539
        always "capabilities" and <code>type</code> is "storage" for a block
        device, "misc" for a character device and "net" for a host network
3540
        interface.
3541 3542 3543 3544 3545
      </dd>
      <dt><code>source</code></dt>
      <dd>The source element describes the device as seen from the host.
        For block devices, the path to the block device in the host
        OS is provided in the nested "block" element, while for character
3546 3547
        devices the "char" element is used. For network interfaces, the
        name of the interface is provided in the "interface" element.
3548 3549 3550
      </dd>
    </dl>

3551 3552 3553 3554 3555 3556 3557 3558 3559 3560 3561 3562 3563
    <h4><a name="elementsRedir">Redirected devices</a></h4>

    <p>
      USB device redirection through a character device is
      supported <span class="since">since after 0.9.5 (KVM
      only)</span>:
    </p>

<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;redirdev bus='usb' type='tcp'&gt;
      &lt;source mode='connect' host='localhost' service='4000'/&gt;
3564
      &lt;boot order='1'/&gt;
3565
    &lt;/redirdev&gt;
3566
    &lt;redirfilter&gt;
3567
      &lt;usbdev class='0x08' vendor='0x1234' product='0xbeef' version='2.56' allow='yes'/&gt;
3568 3569
      &lt;usbdev allow='no'/&gt;
    &lt;/redirfilter&gt;
3570 3571 3572 3573 3574 3575 3576 3577 3578 3579 3580 3581 3582 3583 3584 3585
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>

    <dl>
      <dt><code>redirdev</code></dt>
      <dd>The <code>redirdev</code> element is the main container for
        describing redirected devices. <code>bus</code> must be "usb"
        for a USB device.

        An additional attribute <code>type</code> is required,
        matching one of the
        supported <a href="#elementsConsole">serial device</a> types,
        to describe the host side of the
        tunnel; <code>type='tcp'</code>
        or <code>type='spicevmc'</code> (which uses the usbredir
        channel of a <a href="#elementsGraphics">SPICE graphics
J
Ján Tomko 已提交
3586 3587
        device</a>) are typical. The redirdev element has an optional
        sub-element <code>&lt;address&gt;</code> which can tie the
3588 3589 3590 3591
        device to a particular controller. Further sub-elements,
        such as <code>&lt;source&gt;</code>, may be required according
        to the given type, although a <code>&lt;target&gt;</code> sub-element
        is not required (since the consumer of the character device is
3592 3593 3594 3595 3596 3597 3598 3599 3600 3601
        the hypervisor itself, rather than a device visible in the guest).
      </dd>
      <dt><code>boot</code></dt>

      <dd>Specifies that the device is bootable.
        The <code>order</code> attribute determines the order in which
        devices will be tried during boot sequence. The per-device
        <code>boot</code> elements cannot be used together with general
        boot elements in  <a href="#elementsOSBIOS">BIOS bootloader</a> section.
        (<span class="since">Since 1.0.1</span>)
3602 3603 3604 3605
      </dd>
      <dt><code>redirfilter</code></dt>
      <dd>The<code> redirfilter </code>element is used for creating the
        filter rule to filter out certain devices from redirection.
J
Ján Tomko 已提交
3606 3607
        It uses sub-element <code>&lt;usbdev&gt;</code> to define each filter rule.
        <code>class</code> attribute is the USB Class code, for example,
3608
        0x08 represents mass storage devices. The USB device can be addressed by
J
Ján Tomko 已提交
3609
        vendor / product id using the <code>vendor</code> and <code>product</code> attributes.
3610 3611
        <code>version</code> is the device revision from the bcdDevice field (not
        the version of the USB protocol).
3612
        These four attributes are optional and <code>-1</code> can be used to allow
J
Ján Tomko 已提交
3613
        any value for them. <code>allow</code> attribute is mandatory,
3614 3615
        'yes' means allow, 'no' for deny.
      </dd>
3616 3617
    </dl>

3618 3619 3620 3621 3622 3623 3624 3625 3626 3627 3628 3629 3630 3631 3632 3633 3634 3635 3636 3637 3638 3639 3640 3641 3642 3643 3644 3645 3646 3647
    <h4><a name="elementsSmartcard">Smartcard devices</a></h4>

    <p>
      A virtual smartcard device can be supplied to the guest via the
      <code>smartcard</code> element. A USB smartcard reader device on
      the host cannot be used on a guest with simple device
      passthrough, since it will then not be available on the host,
      possibly locking the host computer when it is "removed".
      Therefore, some hypervisors provide a specialized virtual device
      that can present a smartcard interface to the guest, with
      several modes for describing how credentials are obtained from
      the host or even a from a channel created to a third-party
      smartcard provider. <span class="since">Since 0.8.8</span>
    </p>

<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;smartcard mode='host'/&gt;
    &lt;smartcard mode='host-certificates'&gt;
      &lt;certificate&gt;cert1&lt;/certificate&gt;
      &lt;certificate&gt;cert2&lt;/certificate&gt;
      &lt;certificate&gt;cert3&lt;/certificate&gt;
      &lt;database&gt;/etc/pki/nssdb/&lt;/database&gt;
    &lt;/smartcard&gt;
    &lt;smartcard mode='passthrough' type='tcp'&gt;
      &lt;source mode='bind' host='127.0.0.1' service='2001'/&gt;
      &lt;protocol type='raw'/&gt;
      &lt;address type='ccid' controller='0' slot='0'/&gt;
    &lt;/smartcard&gt;
E
Eric Blake 已提交
3648
    &lt;smartcard mode='passthrough' type='spicevmc'/&gt;
3649 3650 3651 3652 3653 3654 3655 3656 3657 3658 3659 3660 3661 3662 3663 3664 3665 3666 3667 3668 3669 3670 3671 3672 3673 3674 3675 3676 3677 3678 3679 3680 3681 3682 3683 3684 3685 3686 3687 3688 3689 3690
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...
</pre>

    <p>
      The <code>&lt;smartcard&gt;</code> element has a mandatory
      attribute <code>mode</code>.  The following modes are supported;
      in each mode, the guest sees a device on its USB bus that
      behaves like a physical USB CCID (Chip/Smart Card Interface
      Device) card.
    </p>

    <dl>
      <dt><code>mode='host'</code></dt>
      <dd>The simplest operation, where the hypervisor relays all
      requests from the guest into direct access to the host's
      smartcard via NSS.  No other attributes or sub-elements are
      required.  See below about the use of an
      optional <code>&lt;address&gt;</code> sub-element.</dd>

      <dt><code>mode='host-certificates'</code></dt>
      <dd>Rather than requiring a smartcard to be plugged into the
      host, it is possible to provide three NSS certificate names
      residing in a database on the host.  These certificates can be
      generated via the command <code>certutil -d /etc/pki/nssdb -x -t
      CT,CT,CT -S -s CN=cert1 -n cert1</code>, and the resulting three
      certificate names must be supplied as the content of each of
      three <code>&lt;certificate&gt;</code> sub-elements.  An
      additional sub-element <code>&lt;database&gt;</code> can specify
      the absolute path to an alternate directory (matching
      the <code>-d</code> option of the <code>certutil</code> command
      when creating the certificates); if not present, it defaults to
      /etc/pki/nssdb.</dd>

      <dt><code>mode='passthrough'</code></dt>
      <dd>Rather than having the hypervisor directly communicate with
      the host, it is possible to tunnel all requests through a
      secondary character device to a third-party provider (which may
      in turn be talking to a smartcard or using three certificate
      files).  In this mode of operation, an additional
      attribute <code>type</code> is required, matching one of the
      supported <a href="#elementsConsole">serial device</a> types, to
E
Eric Blake 已提交
3691 3692 3693 3694 3695
      describe the host side of the tunnel; <code>type='tcp'</code>
      or <code>type='spicevmc'</code> (which uses the smartcard
      channel of a <a href="#elementsGraphics">SPICE graphics
      device</a>) are typical.  Further sub-elements, such
      as <code>&lt;source&gt;</code>, may be required according to the
3696 3697 3698 3699 3700 3701 3702 3703 3704
      given type, although a <code>&lt;target&gt;</code> sub-element
      is not required (since the consumer of the character device is
      the hypervisor itself, rather than a device visible in the
      guest).</dd>
    </dl>

    <p>
      Each mode supports an optional
      sub-element <code>&lt;address&gt;</code>, which fine-tunes the
3705 3706 3707
      correlation between the smartcard and a ccid bus
      controller, <a href="#elementsAddress">documented above</a>.
      For now, qemu only supports at most one
3708 3709 3710
      smartcard, with an address of bus=0 slot=0.
    </p>

D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
3711 3712
    <h4><a name="elementsNICS">Network interfaces</a></h4>

3713 3714 3715
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
3716 3717 3718
    &lt;interface type='direct' trustGuestRxFilters='yes'&gt;
      &lt;source dev='eth0'/&gt;
      &lt;mac address='52:54:00:5d:c7:9e'/&gt;
3719
      &lt;boot order='1'/&gt;
3720
      &lt;rom bar='off'/&gt;
3721 3722 3723
    &lt;/interface&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
3724

E
Eric Blake 已提交
3725 3726 3727
    <p>
      There are several possibilities for specifying a network
      interface visible to the guest.  Each subsection below provides
3728 3729 3730 3731 3732 3733 3734 3735 3736 3737 3738 3739
      more details about common setup options.
    </p>
    <p>
      <span class="since">Since 1.2.10</span>),
      the <code>interface</code> element
      property <code>trustGuestRxFilters</code> provides the
      capability for the host to detect and trust reports from the
      guest regarding changes to the interface mac address and receive
      filters by setting the attribute to <code>yes</code>. The default
      setting for the attribute is <code>no</code> for security
      reasons and support depends on the guest network device model as
      well as the type of connection on the host - currently it is
C
Chen Fan 已提交
3740
      only supported for the virtio device model and for macvtap
3741 3742 3743 3744
      connections on the host.
    </p>
    <p>
      Each <code>&lt;interface&gt;</code> element has an
E
Eric Blake 已提交
3745 3746
      optional <code>&lt;address&gt;</code> sub-element that can tie
      the interface to a particular pci slot, with
3747 3748
      attribute <code>type='pci'</code>
      as <a href="#elementsAddress">documented above</a>.
E
Eric Blake 已提交
3749 3750
    </p>

D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
3751 3752 3753 3754 3755
    <h5><a name="elementsNICSVirtual">Virtual network</a></h5>

    <p>
      <strong><em>
      This is the recommended config for general guest connectivity on
3756 3757 3758 3759
      hosts with dynamic / wireless networking configs (or multi-host
      environments where the host hardware details are described
      separately in a <code>&lt;network&gt;</code>
      definition <span class="since">Since 0.9.4</span>).
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
3760 3761 3762 3763
      </em></strong>
    </p>

    <p>
3764 3765 3766 3767 3768 3769 3770 3771 3772 3773 3774 3775 3776 3777 3778 3779 3780 3781 3782 3783 3784 3785 3786 3787 3788 3789 3790

      Provides a connection whose details are described by the named
      network definition. Depending on the virtual network's "forward
      mode" configuration, the network may be totally isolated
      (no <code>&lt;forward&gt;</code> element given), NAT'ing to an
      explicit network device or to the default route
      (<code>&lt;forward mode='nat'&gt;</code>), routed with no NAT
      (<code>&lt;forward mode='route'/&gt;</code>), or connected
      directly to one of the host's network interfaces (via macvtap)
      or bridge devices ((<code>&lt;forward
      mode='bridge|private|vepa|passthrough'/&gt;</code> <span class="since">Since
      0.9.4</span>)
    </p>
    <p>
      For networks with a forward mode of bridge, private, vepa, and
      passthrough, it is assumed that the host has any necessary DNS
      and DHCP services already setup outside the scope of libvirt. In
      the case of isolated, nat, and routed networks, DHCP and DNS are
      provided on the virtual network by libvirt, and the IP range can
      be determined by examining the virtual network config with
      '<code>virsh net-dumpxml [networkname]</code>'. There is one
      virtual network called 'default' setup out of the box which does
      NAT'ing to the default route and has an IP range
      of <code>192.168.122.0/255.255.255.0</code>. Each guest will
      have an associated tun device created with a name of vnetN,
      which can also be overridden with the &lt;target&gt; element
      (see
3791
      <a href="#elementsNICSTargetOverride">overriding the target element</a>).
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
3792
    </p>
3793 3794 3795 3796 3797 3798
    <p>
      When the source of an interface is a network,
      a <code>portgroup</code> can be specified along with the name of
      the network; one network may have multiple portgroups defined,
      with each portgroup containing slightly different configuration
      information for different classes of network
3799 3800 3801 3802 3803 3804 3805 3806 3807 3808 3809 3810 3811 3812 3813 3814 3815 3816 3817
      connections. <span class="since">Since 0.9.4</span>.
    </p>
    <p>
      Also, similar to <code>direct</code> network connections
      (described below), a connection of type <code>network</code> may
      specify a <code>virtualport</code> element, with configuration
      data to be forwarded to a vepa (802.1Qbg) or 802.1Qbh compliant
      switch (<span class="since">Since 0.8.2</span>), or to an
      Open vSwitch virtual switch (<span class="since">Since
      0.9.11</span>).
    </p>
    <p>
      Since the actual type of switch may vary depending on the
      configuration in the <code>&lt;network&gt;</code> on the host,
      it is acceptable to omit the virtualport <code>type</code>
      attribute, and specify attributes from multiple different
      virtualport types (and also to leave out certain attributes); at
      domain startup time, a complete <code>&lt;virtualport&gt;</code>
      element will be constructed by merging together the type and
G
Guannan Ren 已提交
3818 3819 3820 3821 3822
      attributes defined in the network and the portgroup referenced
      by the interface. The newly-constructed virtualport is a combination
      of them. The attributes from lower virtualport can't make change
      on the ones defined in higher virtualport.
      Interface takes the highest priority, portgroup is lowest priority.
3823 3824 3825
      (<span class="since">Since 0.10.0</span>). For example, in order
      to work properly with both an 802.1Qbh switch and an Open vSwitch
      switch, you may choose to specify no type, but both
G
Guannan Ren 已提交
3826
      an <code>profileid</code> (in case the switch is 802.1Qbh) and
3827 3828 3829 3830 3831 3832 3833 3834 3835
      an <code>interfaceid</code> (in case the switch is Open vSwitch)
      (you may also omit the other attributes, such as managerid,
      typeid, or profileid, to be filled in from the
      network's <code>&lt;virtualport&gt;</code>). If you want to
      limit a guest to connecting only to certain types of switches,
      you can specify the virtualport type, but still omit some/all of
      the parameters - in this case if the host's network has a
      different type of virtualport, connection of the interface will
      fail.
3836
    </p>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
3837

3838 3839 3840 3841 3842 3843 3844 3845
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;interface type='network'&gt;
      &lt;source network='default'/&gt;
    &lt;/interface&gt;
    ...
    &lt;interface type='network'&gt;
3846
      &lt;source network='default' portgroup='engineering'/&gt;
3847
      &lt;target dev='vnet7'/&gt;
3848
      &lt;mac address="00:11:22:33:44:55"/&gt;
3849 3850
      &lt;virtualport&gt;
        &lt;parameters instanceid='09b11c53-8b5c-4eeb-8f00-d84eaa0aaa4f'/&gt;
3851 3852
      &lt;/virtualport&gt;

3853 3854 3855
    &lt;/interface&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
3856

D
Dan Kenigsberg 已提交
3857
    <h5><a name="elementsNICSBridge">Bridge to LAN</a></h5>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
3858 3859 3860 3861

    <p>
      <strong><em>
      This is the recommended config for general guest connectivity on
3862
      hosts with static wired networking configs.
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
3863 3864 3865 3866
      </em></strong>
    </p>

    <p>
E
Eric Blake 已提交
3867
      Provides a bridge from the VM directly to the LAN. This assumes
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
3868 3869 3870
      there is a bridge device on the host which has one or more of the hosts
      physical NICs enslaved. The guest VM will have an associated tun device
      created with a name of vnetN, which can also be overridden with the
3871 3872 3873 3874 3875
      &lt;target&gt; element (see
      <a href="#elementsNICSTargetOverride">overriding the target element</a>).
      The tun device will be enslaved to the bridge. The IP range / network
      configuration is whatever is used on the LAN. This provides the guest VM
      full incoming &amp; outgoing net access just like a physical machine.
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
3876
    </p>
3877 3878 3879 3880 3881 3882 3883 3884 3885 3886
    <p>
      On Linux systems, the bridge device is normally a standard Linux
      host bridge. On hosts that support Open vSwitch, it is also
      possible to connect to an open vSwitch bridge device by adding
      a <code>&lt;virtualport type='openvswitch'/&gt;</code> to the
      interface definition.  (<span class="since">Since
      0.9.11</span>). The Open vSwitch type virtualport accepts two
      parameters in its <code>&lt;parameters&gt;</code> element -
      an <code>interfaceid</code> which is a standard uuid used to
      uniquely identify this particular interface to Open vSwitch (if
C
Chen Hanxiao 已提交
3887
      you do not specify one, a random interfaceid will be generated
3888 3889 3890 3891
      for you when you first define the interface), and an
      optional <code>profileid</code> which is sent to Open vSwitch as
      the interfaces "port-profile".
    </p>
3892 3893 3894
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
3895
    ...
3896 3897 3898 3899
    &lt;interface type='bridge'&gt;
      &lt;source bridge='br0'/&gt;
    &lt;/interface&gt;
    &lt;interface type='bridge'&gt;
3900
      &lt;source bridge='br1'/&gt;
3901
      &lt;target dev='vnet7'/&gt;
3902
      &lt;mac address="00:11:22:33:44:55"/&gt;
3903
    &lt;/interface&gt;
3904 3905
    &lt;interface type='bridge'&gt;
      &lt;source bridge='ovsbr'/&gt;
E
Eric Blake 已提交
3906
      &lt;virtualport type='openvswitch'&gt;
3907 3908 3909 3910
        &lt;parameters profileid='menial' interfaceid='09b11c53-8b5c-4eeb-8f00-d84eaa0aaa4f'/&gt;
      &lt;/virtualport&gt;
    &lt;/interface&gt;
    ...
3911
  &lt;/devices&gt;
3912 3913 3914 3915 3916 3917 3918 3919 3920 3921 3922 3923 3924 3925 3926 3927 3928 3929 3930 3931 3932 3933 3934 3935 3936 3937 3938 3939 3940 3941 3942 3943 3944 3945
  ...</pre>

    <p>
      On hosts that support Open vSwitch on the kernel side and have the
      Midonet Host Agent configured, it is also possible to connect to the
      'midonet' bridge device by adding a
      <code>&lt;virtualport type='midonet'/&gt;</code> to the
      interface definition.  (<span class="since">Since
      1.2.13</span>). The Midonet virtualport type requires an
      <code>interfaceid</code> attribute in its
      <code>&lt;parameters&gt;</code> element. This interface id is the UUID
      that specifies which port in the virtual network topology will be bound
      to the interface.
    </p>
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    ...
    &lt;interface type='bridge'&gt;
      &lt;source bridge='br0'/&gt;
    &lt;/interface&gt;
    &lt;interface type='bridge'&gt;
      &lt;source bridge='br1'/&gt;
      &lt;target dev='vnet7'/&gt;
      &lt;mac address="00:11:22:33:44:55"/&gt;
    &lt;/interface&gt;
    &lt;interface type='bridge'&gt;
      &lt;source bridge='midonet'/&gt;
      &lt;virtualport type='midonet'&gt;
        &lt;parameters interfaceid='0b2d64da-3d0e-431e-afdd-804415d6ebbb'/&gt;
      &lt;/virtualport&gt;
    &lt;/interface&gt;
    ...
  &lt;/devices&gt;
3946
  ...</pre>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
3947 3948 3949 3950 3951 3952 3953 3954 3955 3956 3957 3958

    <h5><a name="elementsNICSSlirp">Userspace SLIRP stack</a></h5>

    <p>
      Provides a virtual LAN with NAT to the outside world. The virtual
      network has DHCP &amp; DNS services and will give the guest VM addresses
      starting from <code>10.0.2.15</code>. The default router will be
      <code>10.0.2.2</code> and the DNS server will be <code>10.0.2.3</code>.
      This networking is the only option for unprivileged users who need their
      VMs to have outgoing access.
    </p>

3959 3960 3961 3962 3963 3964
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;interface type='user'/&gt;
    ...
    &lt;interface type='user'&gt;
3965
      &lt;mac address="00:11:22:33:44:55"/&gt;
3966 3967 3968
    &lt;/interface&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
3969 3970 3971 3972 3973 3974 3975 3976 3977 3978 3979 3980 3981 3982


    <h5><a name="elementsNICSEthernet">Generic ethernet connection</a></h5>

    <p>
      Provides a means for the administrator to execute an arbitrary script
      to connect the guest's network to the LAN. The guest will have a tun
      device created with a name of vnetN, which can also be overridden with the
      &lt;target&gt; element. After creating the tun device a shell script will
      be run which is expected to do whatever host network integration is
      required. By default this script is called /etc/qemu-ifup but can be
      overridden.
    </p>

3983 3984 3985 3986 3987 3988 3989 3990 3991 3992 3993
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;interface type='ethernet'/&gt;
    ...
    &lt;interface type='ethernet'&gt;
      &lt;target dev='vnet7'/&gt;
      &lt;script path='/etc/qemu-ifup-mynet'/&gt;
    &lt;/interface&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
3994

3995 3996 3997 3998
    <h5><a name="elementsNICSDirect">Direct attachment to physical interface</a></h5>

    <p>
      Provides direct attachment of the virtual machine's NIC to the given
3999
      physical interface of the host.
E
Eric Blake 已提交
4000
      <span class="since">Since 0.7.7 (QEMU and KVM only)</span><br/>
4001 4002 4003
      This setup requires the Linux macvtap
      driver to be available. <span class="since">(Since Linux 2.6.34.)</span>
      One of the modes 'vepa'
4004
      ( <a href="http://www.ieee802.org/1/files/public/docs2009/new-evb-congdon-vepa-modular-0709-v01.pdf">
4005
      'Virtual Ethernet Port Aggregator'</a>), 'bridge' or 'private'
4006
      can be chosen for the operation mode of the macvtap device, 'vepa'
4007 4008
      being the default mode. The individual modes cause the delivery of
      packets to behave as follows:
4009
    </p>
4010 4011 4012 4013 4014 4015 4016 4017 4018 4019 4020 4021
    <p>
      If the model type is set to <code>virtio</code> and
      interface's <code>trustGuestRxFilters</code> attribute is set
      to <code>yes</code>, changes made to the interface mac address,
      unicast/multicast receive filters, and vlan settings in the
      guest will be monitored and propagated to the associated macvtap
      device on the host (<span class="since">Since
      1.2.10</span>). If <code>trustGuestRxFilters</code> is not set,
      or is not supported for the device model in use, an attempted
      change to the mac address originating from the guest side will
      result in a non-working network connection.
    </p>
4022

4023 4024 4025 4026 4027 4028 4029 4030 4031 4032 4033
    <dl>
      <dt><code>vepa</code></dt>
      <dd>All VMs' packets are sent to the external bridge. Packets
      whose destination is a VM on the same host as where the
      packet originates from are sent back to the host by the VEPA
      capable bridge (today's bridges are typically not VEPA capable).</dd>
      <dt><code>bridge</code></dt>
      <dd>Packets whose destination is on the same host as where they
      originate from are directly delivered to the target macvtap device.
      Both origin and destination devices need to be in bridge mode
      for direct delivery. If either one of them is in <code>vepa</code> mode,
E
Eric Blake 已提交
4034
      a VEPA capable bridge is required.</dd>
4035 4036 4037 4038 4039 4040
      <dt><code>private</code></dt>
      <dd>All packets are sent to the external bridge and will only be
      delivered to a target VM on the same host if they are sent through an
      external router or gateway and that device sends them back to the
      host. This procedure is followed if either the source or destination
      device is in <code>private</code> mode.</dd>
4041 4042 4043 4044 4045 4046 4047
      <dt><code>passthrough</code></dt>
      <dd>This feature attaches a virtual function of a SRIOV capable
      NIC directly to a VM without losing the migration capability.
      All packets are sent to the VF/IF of the configured network device.
      Depending on the capabilities of the device additional prerequisites or
      limitations may apply; for example, on Linux this requires
      kernel 2.6.38 or newer. <span class="since">Since 0.9.2</span></dd>
4048 4049
    </dl>

4050 4051 4052 4053
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    ...
4054
    &lt;interface type='direct' trustGuestRxFilters='no'&gt;
4055 4056 4057 4058 4059
      &lt;source dev='eth0' mode='vepa'/&gt;
    &lt;/interface&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>

4060 4061 4062 4063
    <p>
      The network access of direct attached virtual machines can be
      managed by the hardware switch to which the physical interface
      of the host machine is connected to.
E
Eric Blake 已提交
4064
    </p>
4065 4066 4067 4068 4069 4070 4071
    <p>
      The interface can have additional parameters as shown below,
      if the switch is conforming to the IEEE 802.1Qbg standard.
      The parameters of the virtualport element are documented in more detail
      in the IEEE 802.1Qbg standard. The values are network specific and
      should be provided by the network administrator. In 802.1Qbg terms,
      the Virtual Station Interface (VSI) represents the virtual interface
4072
      of a virtual machine. <span class="since">Since 0.8.2</span>
4073
    </p>
4074 4075 4076 4077
    <p>
      Please note that IEEE 802.1Qbg requires a non-zero value for the
      VLAN ID.
    </p>
4078 4079 4080 4081 4082 4083 4084 4085 4086 4087 4088 4089 4090 4091 4092 4093 4094 4095 4096 4097 4098 4099 4100 4101 4102
    <dl>
      <dt><code>managerid</code></dt>
      <dd>The VSI Manager ID identifies the database containing the VSI type
        and instance definitions. This is an integer value and the
        value 0 is reserved.</dd>
      <dt><code>typeid</code></dt>
      <dd>The VSI Type ID identifies a VSI type characterizing the network
        access. VSI types are typically managed by network administrator.
        This is an integer value.
      </dd>
      <dt><code>typeidversion</code></dt>
      <dd>The VSI Type Version allows multiple versions of a VSI Type.
        This is an integer value.
      </dd>
      <dt><code>instanceid</code></dt>
      <dd>The VSI Instance ID Identifier is generated when a VSI instance
        (i.e. a virtual interface of a virtual machine) is created.
        This is a globally unique identifier.
      </dd>
    </dl>
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    ...
    &lt;interface type='direct'&gt;
4103
      &lt;source dev='eth0.2' mode='vepa'/&gt;
4104 4105 4106 4107 4108 4109
      &lt;virtualport type="802.1Qbg"&gt;
        &lt;parameters managerid="11" typeid="1193047" typeidversion="2" instanceid="09b11c53-8b5c-4eeb-8f00-d84eaa0aaa4f"/&gt;
      &lt;/virtualport&gt;
    &lt;/interface&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
4110

4111 4112 4113 4114 4115 4116 4117 4118 4119
    <p>
      The interface can have additional parameters as shown below
      if the switch is conforming to the IEEE 802.1Qbh standard.
      The values are network specific and should be provided by the
      network administrator. <span class="since">Since 0.8.2</span>
    </p>
    <dl>
      <dt><code>profileid</code></dt>
      <dd>The profile ID contains the name of the port profile that is to
E
Eric Blake 已提交
4120
        be applied to this interface.  This name is resolved by the port
4121 4122 4123 4124 4125 4126 4127 4128 4129 4130 4131 4132 4133 4134 4135 4136 4137 4138
        profile database into the network parameters from the port profile,
        and those network parameters will be applied to this interface.
      </dd>
    </dl>
  <pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    ...
    &lt;interface type='direct'&gt;
      &lt;source dev='eth0' mode='private'/&gt;
      &lt;virtualport type='802.1Qbh'&gt;
        &lt;parameters profileid='finance'/&gt;
      &lt;/virtualport&gt;
    &lt;/interface&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...
  </pre>

4139 4140 4141 4142 4143 4144 4145 4146

    <h5><a name="elementsNICSHostdev">PCI Passthrough</a></h5>

    <p>
      A PCI network device (specified by the &lt;source&gt; element)
      is directly assigned to the guest using generic device
      passthrough, after first optionally setting the device's MAC
      address to the configured value, and associating the device with
4147
      an 802.1Qbh capable switch using an optionally specified
4148
      &lt;virtualport&gt; element (see the examples of virtualport
4149 4150 4151 4152 4153 4154 4155 4156 4157
      given above for type='direct' network devices). Note that - due
      to limitations in standard single-port PCI ethernet card driver
      design - only SR-IOV (Single Root I/O Virtualization) virtual
      function (VF) devices can be assigned in this manner; to assign
      a standard single-port PCI or PCIe ethernet card to a guest, use
      the traditional &lt;hostdev&gt; device definition and
      <span class="since">Since 0.9.11</span>
    </p>

4158 4159 4160 4161 4162 4163 4164 4165 4166 4167 4168 4169
    <p>
      To use VFIO device assignment rather than traditional/legacy KVM
      device assignment (VFIO is a new method of device assignment
      that is compatible with UEFI Secure Boot), a type='hostdev'
      interface can have an optional <code>driver</code> sub-element
      with a <code>name</code> attribute set to "vfio". To use legacy
      KVM device assignment you can set <code>name</code> to "kvm" (or
      simply omit the <code>&lt;driver&gt;</code> element, since "kvm"
      is currently the default).
      <span class="since">Since 1.0.5 (QEMU and KVM only, requires kernel 3.6 or newer)</span>
    </p>

4170 4171 4172 4173 4174 4175 4176 4177 4178 4179 4180 4181 4182 4183
    <p>
      Note that this "intelligent passthrough" of network devices is
      very similar to the functionality of a standard &lt;hostdev&gt;
      device, the difference being that this method allows specifying
      a MAC address and &lt;virtualport&gt; for the passed-through
      device. If these capabilities are not required, if you have a
      standard single-port PCI, PCIe, or USB network card that doesn't
      support SR-IOV (and hence would anyway lose the configured MAC
      address during reset after being assigned to the guest domain),
      or if you are using a version of libvirt older than 0.9.11, you
      should use standard &lt;hostdev&gt; to assign the device to the
      guest instead of &lt;interface type='hostdev'/&gt;.
    </p>

4184 4185 4186 4187 4188 4189
    <p>
      Similar to the functionality of a standard &lt;hostdev&gt; device,
      when <code>managed</code> is "yes", it is detached from the host
      before being passed on to the guest, and reattached to the host
      after the guest exits. If <code>managed</code> is omitted or "no",
      the user is responsible to call <code>virNodeDeviceDettach</code>
J
John Ferlan 已提交
4190
      (or <code>virsh nodedev-detach</code>) before starting the guest
4191 4192 4193 4194 4195
      or hot-plugging the device, and <code>virNodeDeviceReAttach</code>
      (or <code>virsh nodedev-reattach</code>) after hot-unplug or
      stopping the guest.
    </p>

4196 4197 4198
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
4199
    &lt;interface type='hostdev' managed='yes'&gt;
4200
      &lt;driver name='vfio'/&gt;
4201 4202 4203
      &lt;source&gt;
        &lt;address type='pci' domain='0x0000' bus='0x00' slot='0x07' function='0x0'/&gt;
      &lt;/source&gt;
4204
      &lt;mac address='52:54:00:6d:90:02'/&gt;
4205 4206 4207 4208 4209 4210 4211 4212
      &lt;virtualport type='802.1Qbh'&gt;
        &lt;parameters profileid='finance'/&gt;
      &lt;/virtualport&gt;
    &lt;/interface&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>


D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
4213 4214 4215 4216 4217 4218 4219 4220 4221 4222 4223 4224 4225 4226
    <h5><a name="elementsNICSMulticast">Multicast tunnel</a></h5>

    <p>
      A multicast group is setup to represent a virtual network. Any VMs
      whose network devices are in the same multicast group can talk to each
      other even across hosts. This mode is also available to unprivileged
      users. There is no default DNS or DHCP support and no outgoing network
      access. To provide outgoing network access, one of the VMs should have a
      2nd NIC which is connected to one of the first 4 network types and do the
      appropriate routing. The multicast protocol is compatible with that used
      by user mode linux guests too. The source address used must be from the
      multicast address block.
    </p>

4227 4228 4229 4230
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;interface type='mcast'&gt;
4231
      &lt;mac address='52:54:00:6d:90:01'/&gt;
4232 4233 4234 4235
      &lt;source address='230.0.0.1' port='5558'/&gt;
    &lt;/interface&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
4236 4237 4238 4239 4240 4241 4242 4243 4244 4245 4246 4247

    <h5><a name="elementsNICSTCP">TCP tunnel</a></h5>

    <p>
      A TCP client/server architecture provides a virtual network. One VM
      provides the server end of the network, all other VMS are configured as
      clients. All network traffic is routed between the VMs via the server.
      This mode is also available to unprivileged users. There is no default
      DNS or DHCP support and no outgoing network access. To provide outgoing
      network access, one of the VMs should have a 2nd NIC which is connected
      to one of the first 4 network types and do the appropriate routing.</p>

4248 4249 4250 4251
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;interface type='server'&gt;
J
Jianwei Hu 已提交
4252
      &lt;mac address='52:54:00:22:c9:42'/&gt;
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
4253
      &lt;source address='192.168.0.1' port='5558'/&gt;
4254 4255 4256
    &lt;/interface&gt;
    ...
    &lt;interface type='client'&gt;
J
Jianwei Hu 已提交
4257
      &lt;mac address='52:54:00:8b:c9:51'/&gt;
4258
      &lt;source address='192.168.0.1' port='5558'/&gt;
4259 4260
    &lt;/interface&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
4261 4262 4263 4264 4265 4266 4267 4268 4269 4270 4271 4272 4273 4274 4275 4276 4277 4278 4279 4280 4281 4282 4283 4284
  ...</pre>

    <h5><a name="elementsNICSUDP">UDP unicast tunnel</a></h5>

    <p>
    A UDP unicast architecture provides a virtual network which enables
    connections between QEMU instances using QEMU's UDP infrastructure.

    The xml "source" address is the endpoint address to which the UDP socket
    packets will be sent from the host running QEMU.
    The xml "local" address is the address of the interface from which the
    UDP socket packets will originate from the QEMU host.
    <span class="since">Since 1.2.20</span></p>

<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;interface type='udp'&gt;
      &lt;mac address='52:54:00:22:c9:42'/&gt;
      &lt;source address='127.0.0.1' port='11115'&gt;
        &lt;local address='127.0.0.1' port='11116'/&gt;
      &lt;/source&gt;
    &lt;/interface&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
4285
  ...</pre>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
4286

4287 4288
    <h5><a name="elementsNICSModel">Setting the NIC model</a></h5>

4289 4290 4291 4292 4293 4294 4295 4296 4297 4298
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;interface type='network'&gt;
      &lt;source network='default'/&gt;
      &lt;target dev='vnet1'/&gt;
      <b>&lt;model type='ne2k_pci'/&gt;</b>
    &lt;/interface&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
4299 4300 4301 4302 4303 4304 4305 4306 4307 4308 4309 4310 4311 4312 4313 4314 4315 4316 4317 4318 4319 4320

    <p>
      For hypervisors which support this, you can set the model of
      emulated network interface card.
    </p>

    <p>
      The values for <code>type</code> aren't defined specifically by
      libvirt, but by what the underlying hypervisor supports (if
      any).  For QEMU and KVM you can get a list of supported models
      with these commands:
    </p>

<pre>
qemu -net nic,model=? /dev/null
qemu-kvm -net nic,model=? /dev/null
</pre>

    <p>
      Typical values for QEMU and KVM include:
      ne2k_isa i82551 i82557b i82559er ne2k_pci pcnet rtl8139 e1000 virtio
    </p>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
4321

4322 4323 4324 4325 4326 4327 4328 4329 4330
    <h5><a name="elementsDriverBackendOptions">Setting NIC driver-specific options</a></h5>

<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;interface type='network'&gt;
      &lt;source network='default'/&gt;
      &lt;target dev='vnet1'/&gt;
      &lt;model type='virtio'/&gt;
4331
      <b>&lt;driver name='vhost' txmode='iothread' ioeventfd='on' event_idx='off' queues='5'&gt;
4332
        &lt;host csum='off' gso='off' tso4='off' tso6='off' ecn='off' ufo='off' mrg_rxbuf='off'/&gt;
4333 4334 4335
        &lt;guest csum='off' tso4='off' tso6='off' ecn='off' ufo='off'/&gt;
      &lt;/driver&gt;
      </b>
4336 4337 4338 4339 4340 4341 4342 4343 4344 4345 4346 4347
    &lt;/interface&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>

    <p>
      Some NICs may have tunable driver-specific options. These are
      set as attributes of the <code>driver</code> sub-element of the
      interface definition. Currently the following attributes are
      available for the <code>"virtio"</code> NIC driver:
    </p>

    <dl>
4348 4349 4350 4351 4352 4353 4354 4355 4356 4357 4358 4359
      <dt><code>name</code></dt>
      <dd>
        The optional <code>name</code> attribute forces which type of
        backend driver to use. The value can be either 'qemu' (a
        user-space backend) or 'vhost' (a kernel backend, which
        requires the vhost module to be provided by the kernel); an
        attempt to require the vhost driver without kernel support
        will be rejected.  If this attribute is not present, then the
        domain defaults to 'vhost' if present, but silently falls back
        to 'qemu' without error.
        <span class="since">Since 0.8.8 (QEMU and KVM only)</span>
      </dd>
4360 4361 4362 4363 4364 4365 4366 4367 4368 4369 4370 4371
      <dd>
        For interfaces of type='hostdev' (PCI passthrough devices)
        the <code>name</code> attribute can optionally be set to
        "vfio" or "kvm". "vfio" tells libvirt to use VFIO device
        assignment rather than traditional KVM device assignment (VFIO
        is a new method of device assignment that is compatible with
        UEFI Secure Boot), and "kvm" tells libvirt to use the legacy
        device assignment performed directly by the kvm kernel module
        (the default is currently "kvm", but is subject to change).
        <span class="since">Since 1.0.5 (QEMU and KVM only, requires
        kernel 3.6 or newer)</span>
      </dd>
4372 4373 4374 4375 4376
      <dd>
        For interfaces of type='vhostuser', the <code>name</code>
        attribute is ignored. The backend driver used is always
        vhost-user.
      </dd>
4377

4378 4379 4380 4381 4382
      <dt><code>txmode</code></dt>
      <dd>
        The <code>txmode</code> attribute specifies how to handle
        transmission of packets when the transmit buffer is full. The
        value can be either 'iothread' or 'timer'.
E
Eric Blake 已提交
4383
        <span class="since">Since 0.8.8 (QEMU and KVM only)</span><br/><br/>
4384 4385 4386 4387

        If set to 'iothread', packet tx is all done in an iothread in
        the bottom half of the driver (this option translates into
        adding "tx=bh" to the qemu commandline -device virtio-net-pci
E
Eric Blake 已提交
4388
        option).<br/><br/>
4389 4390 4391 4392

        If set to 'timer', tx work is done in qemu, and if there is
        more tx data than can be sent at the present time, a timer is
        set before qemu moves on to do other things; when the timer
E
Eric Blake 已提交
4393
        fires, another attempt is made to send more data.<br/><br/>
4394 4395 4396 4397 4398

        The resulting difference, according to the qemu developer who
        added the option is: "bh makes tx more asynchronous and reduces
        latency, but potentially causes more processor bandwidth
        contention since the cpu doing the tx isn't necessarily the
E
Eric Blake 已提交
4399
        cpu where the guest generated the packets."<br/><br/>
4400

4401 4402 4403 4404 4405 4406 4407 4408 4409 4410 4411 4412 4413 4414 4415 4416
        <b>In general you should leave this option alone, unless you
        are very certain you know what you are doing.</b>
      </dd>
      <dt><code>ioeventfd</code></dt>
      <dd>
        This optional attribute allows users to set
        <a href='https://patchwork.kernel.org/patch/43390/'>
        domain I/O asynchronous handling</a> for interface device.
        The default is left to the discretion of the hypervisor.
        Accepted values are "on" and "off". Enabling this allows
        qemu to execute VM while a separate thread handles I/O.
        Typically guests experiencing high system CPU utilization
        during I/O will benefit from this. On the other hand,
        on overloaded host it could increase guest I/O latency.
        <span class="since">Since 0.9.3 (QEMU and KVM only)</span><br/><br/>

4417
        <b>In general you should leave this option alone, unless you
4418 4419 4420 4421 4422 4423
        are very certain you know what you are doing.</b>
      </dd>
      <dt><code>event_idx</code></dt>
      <dd>
        The <code>event_idx</code> attribute controls some aspects of
        device event processing. The value can be either 'on' or 'off'
4424
        - if it is on, it will reduce the number of interrupts and
4425 4426 4427 4428 4429 4430 4431
        exits for the guest. The default is determined by QEMU;
        usually if the feature is supported, default is on. In case
        there is a situation where this behavior is suboptimal, this
        attribute provides a way to force the feature off.
        <span class="since">Since 0.9.5 (QEMU and KVM only)</span><br/><br/>

        <b>In general you should leave this option alone, unless you
4432 4433
        are very certain you know what you are doing.</b>
      </dd>
4434 4435
      <dt><code>queues</code></dt>
      <dd>
4436 4437 4438 4439 4440 4441 4442
        The optional <code>queues</code> attribute controls the number
        of queues to be used for either
        <a href="http://www.linux-kvm.org/page/Multiqueue"> Multiqueue
        virtio-net</a> or <a href="#elementVhostuser">vhost-user</a> network
        interfaces.  Use of multiple packet processing queues requires the
        interface having the <code>&lt;model type='virtio'/&gt;</code>
        element.  Each queue will potentially be handled by a different
4443
        processor, resulting in much higher throughput.
4444
        <span class="since">virtio-net since 1.0.6 (QEMU and KVM only)</span>
4445
        <span class="since">vhost-user since 1.2.17 (QEMU and KVM only)</span>
4446
      </dd>
4447 4448 4449 4450 4451 4452 4453 4454
      <dt><code>host</code> offloading options</dt>
      <dd>
        The <code>csum</code>, <code>gso</code>, <code>tso4</code>,
        <code>tso6</code>, <code>ecn</code> and <code>ufo</code>
        attributes with possible values <code>on</code>
        and <code>off</code> can be used to turn off host offloading options.
        By default, the supported offloads are enabled by QEMU.
        <span class="since">Since 1.2.9 (QEMU only)</span>
4455 4456 4457 4458
        The <code>mrg_rxbuf</code> attribute can be used to control
        mergeable rx buffers on the host side. Possible values are
        <code>on</code> (default) and <code>off</code>.
        <span class="since">Since 1.2.13 (QEMU only)</span>
4459 4460 4461 4462 4463 4464 4465 4466 4467 4468
      </dd>
      <dt><code>guest</code> offloading options</dt>
      <dd>
        The <code>csum</code>, <code>tso4</code>,
        <code>tso6</code>, <code>ecn</code> and <code>ufo</code>
        attributes with possible values <code>on</code>
        and <code>off</code> can be used to turn off guest offloading options.
        By default, the supported offloads are enabled by QEMU.
        <span class="since">Since 1.2.9 (QEMU only)</span>
      </dd>
4469 4470
    </dl>

4471 4472 4473 4474 4475 4476 4477 4478 4479
    <h5><a name="elementsBackendOptions">Setting network backend-specific options</a></h5>

<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;interface type='network'&gt;
      &lt;source network='default'/&gt;
      &lt;target dev='vnet1'/&gt;
      &lt;model type='virtio'/&gt;
4480
      <b>&lt;backend tap='/dev/net/tun' vhost='/dev/vhost-net'/&gt;</b>
4481 4482 4483 4484 4485 4486 4487
      &lt;driver name='vhost' txmode='iothread' ioeventfd='on' event_idx='off' queues='5'/&gt;
    &lt;/interface&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>

    <p>
      For tuning the backend of the network, the <code>backend</code> element
4488 4489
      can be used. The <code>vhost</code> attribute can override the default vhost
      device path (<code>/dev/vhost-net</code>) for devices with <code>virtio</code> model.
4490 4491 4492
      The <code>tap</code> attribute overrides the tun/tap device path (default:
      <code>/dev/net/tun</code>) for network and bridge interfaces. This does not work
      in session mode.
4493
    </p>
4494 4495
    <h5><a name="elementsNICSTargetOverride">Overriding the target element</a></h5>

4496 4497 4498 4499 4500 4501 4502 4503 4504
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;interface type='network'&gt;
      &lt;source network='default'/&gt;
      <b>&lt;target dev='vnet1'/&gt;</b>
    &lt;/interface&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
4505 4506

    <p>
E
Eric Blake 已提交
4507 4508
      If no target is specified, certain hypervisors will
      automatically generate a name for the created tun device. This
4509
      name can be manually specified, however the name <i>must not
E
Eric Blake 已提交
4510 4511 4512
      start with either 'vnet' or 'vif'</i>, which are prefixes
      reserved by libvirt and certain hypervisors. Manually specified
      targets using these prefixes will be ignored.
4513 4514
    </p>

4515 4516 4517 4518 4519 4520 4521 4522 4523 4524 4525 4526 4527 4528 4529 4530 4531
    <p>
      Note that for LXC containers, this defines the name of the interface
      on the host side. <span class="since">Since 1.2.7</span>, to define
      the name of the device on the guest side, the <code>guest</code>
      element should be used, as in the following snippet:
    </p>

<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;interface type='network'&gt;
      &lt;source network='default'/&gt;
      <b>&lt;guest dev='myeth'/&gt;</b>
    &lt;/interface&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>

4532 4533 4534 4535 4536 4537 4538 4539 4540 4541 4542 4543 4544 4545
    <h5><a name="elementsNICSBoot">Specifying boot order</a></h5>

<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;interface type='network'&gt;
      &lt;source network='default'/&gt;
      &lt;target dev='vnet1'/&gt;
      <b>&lt;boot order='1'/&gt;</b>
    &lt;/interface&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>

    <p>
4546
      For hypervisors which support this, you can set a specific NIC to
4547 4548 4549 4550 4551 4552 4553 4554
      be used for network boot. The <code>order</code> attribute determines
      the order in which devices will be tried during boot sequence. The
      per-device <code>boot</code> elements cannot be used together with
      general boot elements in
      <a href="#elementsOSBIOS">BIOS bootloader</a> section.
      <span class="since">Since 0.8.8</span>
    </p>

4555 4556 4557 4558 4559 4560 4561 4562
    <h5><a name="elementsNICSROM">Interface ROM BIOS configuration</a></h5>

<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;interface type='network'&gt;
      &lt;source network='default'/&gt;
      &lt;target dev='vnet1'/&gt;
4563
      <b>&lt;rom bar='on' file='/etc/fake/boot.bin'/&gt;</b>
4564 4565 4566 4567 4568 4569 4570 4571 4572 4573 4574 4575 4576
    &lt;/interface&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>

    <p>
      For hypervisors which support this, you can change how a PCI Network
      device's ROM is presented to the guest. The <code>bar</code>
      attribute can be set to "on" or "off", and determines whether
      or not the device's ROM will be visible in the guest's memory
      map. (In PCI documentation, the "rombar" setting controls the
      presence of the Base Address Register for the ROM). If no rom
      bar is specified, the qemu default will be used (older
      versions of qemu used a default of "off", while newer qemus
4577 4578 4579 4580 4581 4582
      have a default of "on").
      The optional <code>file</code> attribute is used to point to a
      binary file to be presented to the guest as the device's ROM
      BIOS. This can be useful to provide an alternative boot ROM for a
      network device.
      <span class="since">Since 0.9.10 (QEMU and KVM only)</span>.
4583
    </p>
4584 4585 4586 4587 4588 4589 4590 4591 4592 4593 4594 4595 4596 4597 4598 4599 4600 4601 4602 4603 4604 4605 4606
    <h5><a name="elementDomain">Setting up a network backend in a driver domain</a></h5>
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    ...
    &lt;interface type='bridge'&gt;
      &lt;source bridge='br0'/&gt;
      <b>&lt;backenddomain name='netvm'/&gt;</b>
    &lt;/interface&gt;
    ...
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>

    <p>
      The optional <code>backenddomain</code> element allows specifying a
      backend domain (aka driver domain) for the interface. Use the
      <code>name</code> attribute to specify the backend domain name. You
      can use it to create a direct network link between domains (so data
      will not go through host system). Use with type 'ethernet' to create
      plain network link, or with type 'bridge' to connect to a bridge inside
      the backend domain.
      <span class="since">Since 1.2.13 (Xen only)</span>
    </p>
4607

4608 4609 4610 4611 4612 4613 4614 4615 4616
    <h5><a name="elementQoS">Quality of service</a></h5>

<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;interface type='network'&gt;
      &lt;source network='default'/&gt;
      &lt;target dev='vnet0'/&gt;
      <b>&lt;bandwidth&gt;
4617
        &lt;inbound average='1000' peak='5000' floor='200' burst='1024'/&gt;
4618 4619 4620
        &lt;outbound average='128' peak='256' burst='256'/&gt;
      &lt;/bandwidth&gt;</b>
    &lt;/interface&gt;
M
Michele Paolino 已提交
4621
  &lt;/devices&gt;
4622 4623 4624 4625
  ...</pre>

    <p>
      This part of interface XML provides setting quality of service. Incoming
J
John Ferlan 已提交
4626 4627 4628 4629
      and outgoing traffic can be shaped independently.
      The <code>bandwidth</code> element and its child elements are described
      in the <a href="formatnetwork.html#elementQoS">QoS</a> section of
      the Network XML.
4630 4631
    </p>

4632 4633 4634 4635 4636 4637 4638 4639 4640 4641 4642 4643 4644 4645
    <h5><a name="elementVlanTag">Setting VLAN tag (on supported network types only)</a></h5>

<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;interface type='bridge'&gt;
      <b>&lt;vlan&gt;</b>
        <b>&lt;tag id='42'/&gt;</b>
      <b>&lt;/vlan&gt;</b>
      &lt;source bridge='ovsbr0'/&gt;
      &lt;virtualport type='openvswitch'&gt;
        &lt;parameters interfaceid='09b11c53-8b5c-4eeb-8f00-d84eaa0aaa4f'/&gt;
      &lt;/virtualport&gt;
    &lt;/interface&gt;
4646 4647 4648 4649 4650 4651 4652
    &lt;interface type='bridge'&gt;
      <b>&lt;vlan trunk='yes'&gt;</b>
        <b>&lt;tag id='42'/&gt;</b>
        <b>&lt;tag id='123' nativeMode='untagged'/&gt;</b>
      <b>&lt;/vlan&gt;</b>
      ...
    &lt;/interface&gt;
M
Michele Paolino 已提交
4653
  &lt;/devices&gt;
4654 4655 4656 4657 4658 4659 4660 4661 4662 4663 4664 4665 4666 4667 4668
  ...</pre>

    <p>
      If (and only if) the network connection used by the guest
      supports vlan tagging transparent to the guest, an
      optional <code>&lt;vlan&gt;</code> element can specify one or
      more vlan tags to apply to the guest's network
      traffic <span class="since">Since 0.10.0</span>. (openvswitch
      and type='hostdev' SR-IOV interfaces do support transparent vlan
      tagging of guest traffic; everything else, including standard
      linux bridges and libvirt's own virtual networks, <b>do not</b>
      support it. 802.1Qbh (vn-link) and 802.1Qbg (VEPA) switches
      provide their own way (outside of libvirt) to tag guest traffic
      onto specific vlans.) To allow for specification of multiple
      tags (in the case of vlan trunking), a
P
Philipp Hahn 已提交
4669
      subelement, <code>&lt;tag&gt;</code>, specifies which vlan tag
4670 4671 4672 4673 4674 4675 4676 4677 4678
      to use (for example: <code>&lt;tag id='42'/&gt;</code>. If an
      interface has more than one <code>&lt;vlan&gt;</code> element
      defined, it is assumed that the user wants to do VLAN trunking
      using all the specified tags. In the case that vlan trunking
      with a single tag is desired, the optional
      attribute <code>trunk='yes'</code> can be added to the toplevel
      vlan element.
    </p>

4679 4680 4681
    <p>
      For network connections using openvswitch it is possible to
      configure the 'native-tagged' and 'native-untagged' vlan modes
4682
      <span class="since">Since 1.1.0.</span> This uses the optional
4683 4684
      <code>nativeMode</code> attribute on the <code>&lt;tag&gt;</code>
      element: <code>nativeMode</code> may be set to 'tagged' or
4685
      'untagged'. The id attribute of the element sets the native vlan.
4686 4687
    </p>

4688
    <h5><a name="elementLink">Modifying virtual link state</a></h5>
4689 4690 4691 4692 4693 4694 4695 4696
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;interface type='network'&gt;
      &lt;source network='default'/&gt;
      &lt;target dev='vnet0'/&gt;
      <b>&lt;link state='down'/&gt;</b>
    &lt;/interface&gt;
M
Michele Paolino 已提交
4697
  &lt;/devices&gt;
4698 4699 4700 4701 4702 4703 4704 4705 4706 4707 4708
  ...</pre>

    <p>
      This element provides means of setting state of the virtual network link.
      Possible values for attribute <code>state</code> are <code>up</code> and
      <code>down</code>. If <code>down</code> is specified as the value, the interface
      behaves as if it had the network cable disconnected. Default behavior if this
      element is unspecified is to have the link state <code>up</code>.
      <span class="since">Since 0.9.5</span>
    </p>

4709 4710 4711 4712 4713 4714 4715
    <h5><a name="ipconfig">IP configuration</a></h5>
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;interface type='network'&gt;
      &lt;source network='default'/&gt;
      &lt;target dev='vnet0'/&gt;
4716
      <b>&lt;ip address='192.168.122.5' prefix='24'/&gt;</b>
4717
      <b>&lt;route family='ipv4' address='192.168.122.0' prefix='24' gateway='192.168.122.1'/&gt;</b>
4718
      <b>&lt;route family='ipv4' address='192.168.122.8' gateway='192.168.122.1'/&gt;</b>
4719
    &lt;/interface&gt;
4720 4721 4722 4723 4724
    ...
    &lt;hostdev mode='capabilities' type='net'&gt;
      &lt;source&gt;
        &lt;interface&gt;eth0&lt;/interface&gt;
      &lt;/source&gt;
4725
      <b>&lt;ip address='192.168.122.6' prefix='24'/&gt;</b>
4726
      <b>&lt;route family='ipv4' address='192.168.122.0' prefix='24' gateway='192.168.122.1'/&gt;</b>
4727
      <b>&lt;route family='ipv4' address='192.168.122.8' gateway='192.168.122.1'/&gt;</b>
4728 4729
    &lt;/hostdev&gt;

4730 4731 4732 4733 4734 4735 4736 4737 4738 4739 4740 4741 4742 4743
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...
</pre>

    <p>
    <span class="since">Since 1.2.12</span> the network devices and host devices
    with network capabilities can be provided zero or more IP addresses to set
    on the target device. Note that some hypervisors or network device types
    will simply ignore them or only use the first one. The <code>family</code>
    attribute can be set to either <code>ipv4</code> or <code>ipv6</code>, the
    <code>address</code> attribute holds the IP address. The <code>prefix</code>
    is not mandatory since some hypervisors do not handle it.
    </p>

4744 4745
    <p>
    <span class="since">Since 1.2.12</span> route elements can also be added
4746 4747 4748
    to define the network routes to use for the network device. The attributes
    of this element are described in the documentation for the <code>route</code>
    element in <a href="formatnetwork.html#elementsStaticroute">network definitions</a>.
4749 4750 4751
    This is only used by the LXC driver.
    </p>

M
Michele Paolino 已提交
4752 4753 4754 4755 4756 4757 4758 4759 4760 4761 4762 4763 4764 4765
    <h5><a name="elementVhostuser">vhost-user interface</a></h5>

    <p>
    <span class="since">Since 1.2.7</span> the vhost-user enables the
    communication between a QEMU virtual machine and other userspace process
    using the Virtio transport protocol.  A char dev (e.g. Unix socket) is used
    for the control plane, while the data plane is based on shared memory.
    </p>

<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;interface type='vhostuser'&gt;
      &lt;mac address='52:54:00:3b:83:1a'/&gt;
4766
      &lt;source type='unix' path='/tmp/vhost1.sock' mode='server'/&gt;
M
Michele Paolino 已提交
4767 4768
      &lt;model type='virtio'/&gt;
    &lt;/interface&gt;
4769 4770 4771 4772 4773 4774
    &lt;interface type='vhostuser'&gt;
      &lt;mac address='52:54:00:3b:83:1b'/&gt;
      &lt;source type='unix' path='/tmp/vhost2.sock' mode='client'/&gt;
      &lt;model type='virtio'/&gt;
      &lt;driver queues='5'/&gt;
    &lt;/interface&gt;
M
Michele Paolino 已提交
4775 4776 4777 4778 4779 4780 4781 4782 4783 4784 4785 4786 4787 4788
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>

    <p>
      The <code>&lt;source&gt;</code> element has to be specified
      along with the type of char device.
      Currently, only type='unix' is supported, where the path (the
      directory path of the socket) and mode attributes are required.
      Both <code>mode='server'</code> and <code>mode='client'</code>
      are supported.
      vhost-user requires the virtio model type, thus the
      <code>&lt;model&gt;</code> element is mandatory.
    </p>

D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
4789 4790 4791
    <h4><a name="elementsInput">Input devices</a></h4>

    <p>
E
Eric Blake 已提交
4792 4793 4794 4795
      Input devices allow interaction with the graphical framebuffer
      in the guest virtual machine. When enabling the framebuffer, an
      input device is automatically provided. It may be possible to
      add additional devices explicitly, for example,
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
4796 4797 4798
      to provide a graphics tablet for absolute cursor movement.
    </p>

4799 4800 4801 4802
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;input type='mouse' bus='usb'/&gt;
4803
    &lt;input type='keyboard' bus='usb'/&gt;
4804 4805 4806
    &lt;input type='mouse' bus='virtio'/&gt;
    &lt;input type='keyboard' bus='virtio'/&gt;
    &lt;input type='tablet' bus='virtio'/&gt;
4807 4808 4809
    &lt;input type='passthrough' bus='virtio'&gt;
      &lt;source evdev='/dev/input/event1/&gt;
    &lt;/input&gt;
4810 4811
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
4812 4813 4814

    <dl>
      <dt><code>input</code></dt>
E
Eric Blake 已提交
4815
      <dd>The <code>input</code> element has one mandatory attribute,
4816 4817 4818
        the <code>type</code> whose value can be 'mouse', 'tablet',
        (<span class="since">since 1.2.2</span>) 'keyboard' or
        (<span class="since">since 1.3.0</span>) 'passthrough'.
4819 4820
        The tablet provides absolute cursor movement,
        while the mouse uses relative movement. The optional
M
Matthew Booth 已提交
4821
        <code>bus</code> attribute can be used to refine the exact device type.
4822 4823
        It takes values "xen" (paravirtualized), "ps2" and "usb" or
        (<span class="since">since 1.3.0</span>) "virtio".</dd>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
4824 4825
    </dl>

E
Eric Blake 已提交
4826 4827 4828
    <p>
      The <code>input</code> element has an optional
      sub-element <code>&lt;address&gt;</code> which can tie the
4829 4830
      device to a particular PCI
      slot, <a href="#elementsAddress">documented above</a>.
4831 4832 4833 4834

      For type <code>passthrough</code>, the mandatory sub-element <code>source</code>
      must have an <code>evdev</code> attribute containing the absolute path to the
      event device passed through to guests. (KVM only)
E
Eric Blake 已提交
4835
    </p>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
4836

M
Marc-André Lureau 已提交
4837 4838 4839 4840 4841 4842 4843 4844 4845 4846 4847 4848 4849 4850 4851 4852 4853 4854 4855 4856 4857 4858 4859
    <h4><a name="elementsHub">Hub devices</a></h4>

    <p>
      A hub is a device that expands a single port into several so
      that there are more ports available to connect devices to a host
      system.
    </p>

<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;hub type='usb'/&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>

    <dl>
      <dt><code>hub</code></dt>
      <dd>The <code>hub</code> element has one mandatory attribute,
        the <code>type</code> whose value can only be 'usb'.</dd>
    </dl>

    <p>
      The <code>hub</code> element has an optional
4860 4861 4862 4863
      sub-element <code>&lt;address&gt;</code>
      with <code>type='usb'</code>which can tie the device to a
      particular controller, <a href="#elementsAddress">documented
      above</a>.
M
Marc-André Lureau 已提交
4864 4865
    </p>

D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
4866 4867 4868 4869 4870 4871 4872 4873 4874
    <h4><a name="elementsGraphics">Graphical framebuffers</a></h4>

    <p>
      A graphics device allows for graphical interaction with the
      guest OS. A guest will typically have either a framebuffer
      or a text console configured to allow interaction with the
      admin.
    </p>

4875 4876 4877 4878
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;graphics type='sdl' display=':0.0'/&gt;
4879
    &lt;graphics type='vnc' port='5904' sharePolicy='allow-exclusive'&gt;
4880 4881
      &lt;listen type='address' address='1.2.3.4'/&gt;
    &lt;/graphics&gt;
4882 4883
    &lt;graphics type='rdp' autoport='yes' multiUser='yes' /&gt;
    &lt;graphics type='desktop' fullscreen='yes'/&gt;
4884 4885 4886
    &lt;graphics type='spice'&gt;
      &lt;listen type='network' network='rednet'/&gt;
    &lt;/graphics&gt;
4887 4888
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
4889 4890 4891 4892

    <dl>
      <dt><code>graphics</code></dt>
      <dd>The <code>graphics</code> element has a mandatory <code>type</code>
E
Eric Blake 已提交
4893
        attribute which takes the value "sdl", "vnc", "rdp" or "desktop":
4894 4895 4896
        <dl>
          <dt><code>"sdl"</code></dt>
          <dd>
E
Eric Blake 已提交
4897 4898 4899 4900 4901 4902
            This displays a window on the host desktop, it can take 3
            optional arguments: a <code>display</code> attribute for
            the display to use, an <code>xauth</code> attribute for
            the authentication identifier, and an
            optional <code>fullscreen</code> attribute accepting
            values 'yes' or 'no'.
4903 4904 4905
          </dd>
          <dt><code>"vnc"</code></dt>
          <dd>
E
Eric Blake 已提交
4906 4907 4908 4909 4910 4911 4912 4913 4914 4915 4916 4917
            Starts a VNC server. The <code>port</code> attribute
            specifies the TCP port number (with -1 as legacy syntax
            indicating that it should be
            auto-allocated). The <code>autoport</code> attribute is
            the new preferred syntax for indicating autoallocation of
            the TCP port to use.  The <code>listen</code> attribute is
            an IP address for the server to listen
            on. The <code>passwd</code> attribute provides a VNC
            password in clear text. The <code>keymap</code> attribute
            specifies the keymap to use. It is possible to set a limit
            on the validity of the password be giving an
            timestamp <code>passwdValidTo='2010-04-09T15:51:00'</code>
4918 4919 4920 4921
            assumed to be in UTC. The <code>connected</code> attribute
            allows control of connected client during password changes.
            VNC accepts <code>keep</code> value only.
            <span class="since">since 0.9.3</span>
4922 4923 4924 4925 4926 4927 4928 4929 4930 4931
            NB, this may not be supported by all hypervisors.<br/>
            The optional <code>sharePolicy</code> attribute specifies vnc server
            display sharing policy. "allow-exclusive" allows clients to ask
            for exclusive access by dropping other connections. Connecting
            multiple clients in parallel requires all clients asking for a
            shared session (vncviewer: -Shared switch). This is the default
            value. "force-shared" disables exclusive client access, every
            connection has to specify -Shared switch for vncviewer. "ignore"
            welcomes every connection unconditionally
            <span class="since">since 1.0.6</span>. <br/> <br/>
4932 4933 4934
            Rather than using listen/port, QEMU supports a
            <code>socket</code> attribute for listening on a unix
            domain socket path.<span class="since">Since 0.8.8</span>
M
Martin Kletzander 已提交
4935 4936 4937 4938 4939 4940

            For VNC WebSocket functionality, <code>websocket</code>
            attribute may be used to specify port to listen on (with
            -1 meaning auto-allocation and <code>autoport</code>
            having no effect due to security reasons).
            <span class="since">Since 1.0.6</span>
4941 4942 4943
          </dd>
          <dt><code>"spice"</code></dt>
          <dd>
E
Eric Blake 已提交
4944
            <p>
E
Eric Blake 已提交
4945 4946 4947 4948 4949 4950
              Starts a SPICE server. The <code>port</code> attribute
              specifies the TCP port number (with -1 as legacy syntax
              indicating that it should be auto-allocated),
              while <code>tlsPort</code> gives an alternative secure
              port number. The <code>autoport</code> attribute is the
              new preferred syntax for indicating autoallocation of
4951
              needed port numbers.  The <code>listen</code> attribute is
E
Eric Blake 已提交
4952 4953 4954 4955 4956 4957
              an IP address for the server to listen
              on. The <code>passwd</code> attribute provides a SPICE
              password in clear text. The <code>keymap</code>
              attribute specifies the keymap to use. It is possible to
              set a limit on the validity of the password be giving an
              timestamp <code>passwdValidTo='2010-04-09T15:51:00'</code>
4958 4959 4960 4961 4962 4963 4964 4965
              assumed to be in UTC. The <code>connected</code> attribute
              allows control of connected client during password changes.
              SPICE accepts <code>keep</code> to keep client connected,
              <code>disconnect</code> to disconnect client and
              <code>fail</code> to fail changing password.
              <span class="since">Since 0.9.3</span>
              NB, this may not be supported by all hypervisors.
              <span class="since">"spice" since 0.8.6</span>.
4966 4967 4968 4969 4970 4971 4972
              The <code>defaultMode</code> attribute sets the default channel
              security policy, valid values are <code>secure</code>,
              <code>insecure</code> and the default <code>any</code>
              (which is secure if possible, but falls back to insecure
              rather than erroring out if no secure path is
              available). <span class="since">"defaultMode" since
              0.9.12</span>.
E
Eric Blake 已提交
4973 4974
            </p>
            <p>
E
Eric Blake 已提交
4975 4976 4977 4978
              When SPICE has both a normal and TLS secured TCP port
              configured, it can be desirable to restrict what
              channels can be run on each port.  This is achieved by
              adding one or more &lt;channel&gt; elements inside the
4979 4980 4981 4982 4983 4984 4985
              main &lt;graphics&gt; element and setting the <code>mode</code>
              attribute to either <code>secure</code> or <code>insecure</code>.
              Setting the mode attribute overrides the default value as set
              by the <code>defaultMode</code> attribute. (Note that specifying
              <code>any</code> as mode discards the entry as the channel would
              inherit the default mode anyways)
              Valid channel names
E
Eric Blake 已提交
4986 4987
              include <code>main</code>, <code>display</code>,
              <code>inputs</code>, <code>cursor</code>,
4988 4989 4990 4991 4992
              <code>playback</code>, <code>record</code>
              (all <span class="since"> since 0.8.6</span>);
              <code>smartcard</code> (<span class="since">since
              0.8.8</span>); and <code>usbredir</code>
              (<span class="since">since 0.9.12</span>).
E
Eric Blake 已提交
4993 4994
            </p>
            <pre>
4995 4996 4997
  &lt;graphics type='spice' port='-1' tlsPort='-1' autoport='yes'&gt;
    &lt;channel name='main' mode='secure'/&gt;
    &lt;channel name='record' mode='insecure'/&gt;
4998
    &lt;image compression='auto_glz'/&gt;
4999
    &lt;streaming mode='filter'/&gt;
5000
    &lt;clipboard copypaste='no'/&gt;
P
Peng Zhou 已提交
5001
    &lt;mouse mode='client'/&gt;
5002
    &lt;filetransfer enable='no'/&gt;
5003
  &lt;/graphics&gt;</pre>
5004 5005 5006 5007 5008 5009 5010 5011 5012 5013 5014 5015 5016 5017 5018 5019 5020
            <p>
              Spice supports variable compression settings for audio,
              images and streaming, <span class="since">since
              0.9.1</span>.  These settings are accessible via
              the <code>compression</code> attribute in all following
              elements: <code>image</code> to set image compression
              (accepts <code>auto_glz</code>, <code>auto_lz</code>,
              <code>quic</code>, <code>glz</code>, <code>lz</code>,
              <code>off</code>), <code>jpeg</code> for JPEG
              compression for images over wan
              (accepts <code>auto</code>, <code>never</code>,
              <code>always</code>), <code>zlib</code> for configuring
              wan image compression (accepts <code>auto</code>,
              <code>never</code>, <code>always</code>)
              and <code>playback</code> for enabling audio stream
              compression (accepts <code>on</code> or <code>off</code>).
            </p>
5021 5022
            <p>
              Streaming mode is set by the <code>streaming</code>
Z
Zhou Peng 已提交
5023
              element, settings its <code>mode</code> attribute to one
5024 5025 5026
              of <code>filter</code>, <code>all</code>
              or <code>off</code>, <span class="since">since 0.9.2</span>.
            </p>
5027 5028 5029 5030 5031 5032 5033
            <p>
              Copy &amp; Paste functionality (via Spice agent) is set
              by the <code>clipboard</code> element. It is enabled by
              default, and can be disabled by setting
              the <code>copypaste</code> property
              to <code>no</code>, <span class="since">since
              0.9.3</span>.
5034
            </p>
P
Peng Zhou 已提交
5035
            <p>
Z
Zhou Peng 已提交
5036 5037
              Mouse mode is set by the <code>mouse</code> element,
              setting its <code>mode</code> attribute to one of
P
Peng Zhou 已提交
5038 5039 5040 5041
              <code>server</code> or <code>client</code> ,
              <span class="since">since 0.9.11</span>. If no mode is
              specified, the qemu default will be used (client mode).
            </p>
5042 5043 5044 5045 5046 5047 5048
            <p>
              File transfer functionality (via Spice agent) is set using the
              <code>filetransfer</code> element.
              It is enabled by default, and can be disabled by setting the
              <code>enable</code> property to <code>no</code> ,
              since <span class="since">since 1.2.2</span>.
            </p>
5049 5050 5051
          </dd>
          <dt><code>"rdp"</code></dt>
          <dd>
E
Eric Blake 已提交
5052 5053 5054 5055 5056 5057 5058 5059
            Starts a RDP server. The <code>port</code> attribute
            specifies the TCP port number (with -1 as legacy syntax
            indicating that it should be
            auto-allocated). The <code>autoport</code> attribute is
            the new preferred syntax for indicating autoallocation of
            the TCP port to use. The <code>replaceUser</code>
            attribute is a boolean deciding whether multiple
            simultaneous connections to the VM are permitted.
5060 5061 5062 5063
            The <code>multiUser</code> attribute is a boolean deciding
            whether the existing connection must be dropped and a new
            connection must be established by the VRDP server, when a
            new client connects in single connection mode.
5064 5065 5066
          </dd>
          <dt><code>"desktop"</code></dt>
          <dd>
E
Eric Blake 已提交
5067 5068 5069 5070 5071 5072
            This value is reserved for VirtualBox domains for the
            moment. It displays a window on the host desktop,
            similarly to "sdl", but using the VirtualBox viewer. Just
            like "sdl", it accepts the optional
            attributes <code>display</code>
            and <code>fullscreen</code>.
5073 5074 5075 5076 5077
          </dd>
        </dl>
      </dd>
    </dl>

5078 5079 5080 5081 5082 5083 5084 5085 5086 5087 5088 5089 5090 5091 5092 5093 5094 5095 5096 5097 5098 5099 5100 5101 5102 5103 5104 5105 5106 5107 5108 5109 5110 5111 5112 5113 5114 5115 5116 5117 5118 5119 5120 5121 5122 5123 5124 5125
    <p>
      Rather than putting the address information used to set up the
      listening socket for graphics types <code>vnc</code>
      and <code>spice</code> in
      the <code>&lt;graphics&gt;</code> <code>listen</code> attribute,
      a separate subelement of <code>&lt;graphics&gt;</code>,
      called <code>&lt;listen&gt;</code> can be specified (see the
      examples above)<span class="since">since
      0.9.4</span>. <code>&lt;listen&gt;</code> accepts the following
      attributes:
    </p>
    <dl>
      <dt><code>type</code></dt>
      <dd>Set to either <code>address</code>
        or <code>network</code>. This tells whether this listen
        element is specifying the address to be used directly, or by
        naming a network (which will then be used to determine an
        appropriate address for listening).
      </dd>
    </dl>
    <dl>
      <dt><code>address</code></dt>
      <dd>if <code>type='address'</code>, the <code>address</code>
        attribute will contain either an IP address or hostname (which
        will be resolved to an IP address via a DNS query) to listen
        on. In the "live" XML of a running domain, this attribute will
        be set to the IP address used for listening, even
        if <code>type='network'</code>.
      </dd>
    </dl>
    <dl>
      <dt><code>network</code></dt>
      <dd>if <code>type='network'</code>, the <code>network</code>
        attribute will contain the name of a network in libvirt's list
        of configured networks. The named network configuration will
        be examined to determine an appropriate listen address. For
        example, if the network has an IPv4 address in its
        configuration (e.g. if it has a forward type
        of <code>route</code>, <code>nat</code>, or no forward type
        (isolated)), the first IPv4 address listed in the network's
        configuration will be used. If the network is describing a
        host bridge, the first IPv4 address associated with that
        bridge device will be used, and if the network is describing
        one of the 'direct' (macvtap) modes, the first IPv4 address of
        the first forward dev will be used.
      </dd>
    </dl>

5126 5127 5128 5129 5130
    <h4><a name="elementsVideo">Video devices</a></h4>
    <p>
      A video device.
    </p>

5131 5132 5133 5134
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;video&gt;
5135
      &lt;model type='vga' vram='16384' heads='1'&gt;
5136
        &lt;acceleration accel3d='yes' accel2d='yes'/&gt;
5137 5138 5139 5140
      &lt;/model&gt;
    &lt;/video&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
5141 5142 5143

    <dl>
      <dt><code>video</code></dt>
5144
      <dd>
5145 5146 5147 5148 5149 5150 5151 5152 5153 5154 5155 5156 5157 5158 5159 5160
        <p>
          The <code>video</code> element is the container for describing
          video devices. For backwards compatibility, if no <code>video</code>
          is set but there is a <code>graphics</code> in domain xml, then
          libvirt will add a default <code>video</code> according to the guest
          type.
        </p>
        <p>
          For a guest of type "kvm", the default <code>video</code> is:
          <code>type</code> with value "cirrus", <code>vram</code> with value
          "16384" and <code>heads</code> with value "1". By default, the first
          video device in domain xml is the primary one, but the optional
          attribute <code>primary</code> (<span class="since">since 1.0.2</span>)
          with value 'yes' can be used to mark the primary in cases of multiple
          video device. The non-primary must be type of "qxl".
        </p>
5161
      </dd>
5162

5163 5164
      <dt><code>model</code></dt>
      <dd>
5165 5166 5167
        <p>
          The <code>model</code> element has a mandatory <code>type</code>
          attribute which takes the value "vga", "cirrus", "vmvga", "xen",
M
Marc-André Lureau 已提交
5168 5169 5170
          "vbox", "qxl" (<span class="since">since 0.8.6</span>) or
          "virtio" (<span class="since">since 1.3.0</span>)
          depending on the hypervisor features available.
5171 5172 5173 5174
        </p>
        <p>
          You can provide the amount of video memory in kibibytes (blocks of
          1024 bytes) using <code>vram</code>. This is supported only for guest
5175
          type of "libxl", "vz", "qemu", "vbox", "vmx" and "xen". If no
5176 5177 5178 5179 5180
          value is provided the default is used. If the size is not a power of
          two it will be rounded to closest one.
        </p>
        <p>
          The number of screen can be set using <code>heads</code>. This is
5181
          supported only for guests type of "vz", "kvm", "vbox" and "vmx".
5182 5183 5184 5185 5186 5187 5188
        </p>
        <p>
          For guest type of kvm the optional attribute <code>ram</code>
          (<span class="since">since 1.0.2</span>) is allowed for "qxl" type
          only and specifies the size of the primary bar, while the optional
          attribute <code>vram</code> specifies the secondary bar size.
          If "ram" or "vram" are not supplied a default value is used. The ram
5189 5190 5191 5192
          should also be rounded to power of two as vram. There is also optional
          attribute <code>vgamem</code> (<span class="since">since 1.2.11 (QEMU
          only)</span>) to set the size of VGA framebuffer for fallback mode of
          QXL device.
5193
        </p>
5194 5195 5196 5197 5198 5199 5200 5201
      </dd>

      <dt><code>acceleration</code></dt>
      <dd>
        If acceleration should be enabled (if supported) using the
        <code>accel3d</code> and <code>accel2d</code> attributes in the
        <code>acceleration</code> element.
      </dd>
E
Eric Blake 已提交
5202 5203 5204 5205 5206 5207

      <dt><code>address</code></dt>
      <dd>
        The optional <code>address</code> sub-element can be used to
        tie the video device to a particular PCI slot.
      </dd>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5208 5209
    </dl>

5210
    <h4><a name="elementsConsole">Consoles, serial, parallel &amp; channel devices</a></h4>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5211 5212 5213

    <p>
      A character device provides a way to interact with the virtual machine.
5214 5215
      Paravirtualized consoles, serial ports, parallel ports and channels are
      all classed as character devices and so represented using the same syntax.
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5216 5217
    </p>

5218 5219 5220 5221 5222 5223 5224 5225 5226 5227 5228
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;parallel type='pty'&gt;
      &lt;source path='/dev/pts/2'/&gt;
      &lt;target port='0'/&gt;
    &lt;/parallel&gt;
    &lt;serial type='pty'&gt;
      &lt;source path='/dev/pts/3'/&gt;
      &lt;target port='0'/&gt;
    &lt;/serial&gt;
5229
    &lt;serial type='file'&gt;
5230
      &lt;source path='/tmp/file' append='on'&gt;
5231 5232
        &lt;seclabel model='dac' relabel='no'/&gt;
      &lt;/source&gt;
5233
      &lt;target port='0'/&gt;
5234
    &lt;/serial&gt;
5235 5236 5237 5238 5239 5240 5241 5242 5243 5244
    &lt;console type='pty'&gt;
      &lt;source path='/dev/pts/4'/&gt;
      &lt;target port='0'/&gt;
    &lt;/console&gt;
    &lt;channel type='unix'&gt;
      &lt;source mode='bind' path='/tmp/guestfwd'/&gt;
      &lt;target type='guestfwd' address='10.0.2.1' port='4600'/&gt;
    &lt;/channel&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5245

5246 5247 5248 5249 5250
    <p>
      In each of these directives, the top-level element name (parallel, serial,
      console, channel) describes how the device is presented to the guest. The
      guest interface is configured by the <code>target</code> element.
    </p>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5251

5252 5253 5254 5255 5256 5257
    <p>
      The interface presented to the host is given in the <code>type</code>
      attribute of the top-level element. The host interface is
      configured by the <code>source</code> element.
    </p>

5258 5259 5260 5261 5262 5263 5264 5265
    <p>
      The <code>source</code> element may contain an optional
      <code>seclabel</code> to override the way that labelling
      is done on the socket path.  If this element is not present,
      the <a href="#seclabel">security label is inherited from
        the per-domain setting</a>.
    </p>

5266 5267 5268 5269 5270 5271 5272 5273
    <p>
      If the interface <code>type</code> presented to the host is "file",
      then the <code>source</code> element may contain an optional attribute
      <code>append</code> that specifies whether or not the information in
      the file should be preserved on domain restart. Allowed values are
      "on" and "off" (default). <span class="since">Since 1.3.1</span>.
    </p>

E
Eric Blake 已提交
5274 5275 5276 5277 5278 5279 5280 5281
    <p>
      Each character device element has an optional
      sub-element <code>&lt;address&gt;</code> which can tie the
      device to a
      particular <a href="#elementsControllers">controller</a> or PCI
      slot.
    </p>

5282 5283 5284 5285 5286 5287 5288 5289 5290
    <h5><a name="elementsCharGuestInterface">Guest interface</a></h5>

    <p>
      A character device presents itself to the guest as one of the following
      types.
    </p>

    <h6><a name="elementCharParallel">Parallel port</a></h6>

5291 5292 5293 5294 5295 5296 5297 5298 5299
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;parallel type='pty'&gt;
      &lt;source path='/dev/pts/2'/&gt;
      &lt;target port='0'/&gt;
    &lt;/parallel&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
5300 5301 5302

    <p>
      <code>target</code> can have a <code>port</code> attribute, which
5303
      specifies the port number. Ports are numbered starting from 0. There are
5304 5305 5306 5307 5308
      usually 0, 1 or 2 parallel ports.
    </p>

    <h6><a name="elementCharSerial">Serial port</a></h6>

5309 5310 5311 5312 5313 5314 5315 5316 5317
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;serial type='pty'&gt;
      &lt;source path='/dev/pts/3'/&gt;
      &lt;target port='0'/&gt;
    &lt;/serial&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
5318 5319 5320

    <p>
      <code>target</code> can have a <code>port</code> attribute, which
5321
      specifies the port number. Ports are numbered starting from 0. There are
G
Guannan Ren 已提交
5322 5323
      usually 0, 1 or 2 serial ports. There is also an optional
      <code>type</code> attribute <span class="since">since 1.0.2</span>
M
Michal Privoznik 已提交
5324 5325 5326 5327 5328 5329 5330 5331 5332 5333
      which has three choices for its value, one is <code>isa-serial</code>,
      then <code>usb-serial</code> and last one is <code>pci-serial</code>.
      If <code>type</code> is missing, <code>isa-serial</code> will be used by
      default. For <code>usb-serial</code> an optional sub-element
      <code>&lt;address/&gt;</code> with <code>type='usb'</code> can tie the
      device to a particular controller, <a href="#elementsAddress">documented above</a>.
      Similarly, <code>pci-serial</code> can be used to attach the device to
      the pci bus (<span class="since">since 1.2.16</span>). Again, it has
      optional sub-element <code>&lt;address/&gt;</code> with
      <code>type='pci'</code> to select desired location on the PCI bus.
5334 5335 5336 5337 5338
    </p>

    <h6><a name="elementCharConsole">Console</a></h6>

    <p>
5339 5340 5341 5342 5343 5344 5345
      The console element is used to represent interactive consoles. Depending
      on the type of guest in use, the consoles might be paravirtualized devices,
      or they might be a clone of a serial device, according to the following
      rules:
    </p>

    <ul>
5346
      <li>If no <code>targetType</code> attribute is set, then the default
5347 5348 5349 5350 5351 5352 5353 5354 5355 5356 5357 5358 5359
        device type is according to the hypervisor's rules. The default
        type will be added when re-querying the XML fed into libvirt.
        For fully virtualized guests, the default device type will usually
        be a serial port.</li>
      <li>If the <code>targetType</code> attribute is <code>serial</code>,
        then if no <code>&lt;serial&gt;</code> element exists, the console
        element will be copied to the serial element. If a <code>&lt;serial&gt;</code>
        element does already exist, the console element will be ignored.</li>
      <li>If the <code>targetType</code> attribute is not <code>serial</code>,
        it will be treated normally.</li>
      <li>Only the first <code>console</code> element may use a <code>targetType</code>
        of <code>serial</code>. Secondary consoles must all be paravirtualized.
      </li>
5360 5361 5362 5363 5364 5365
      <li>On s390, the <code>console</code> element may use a
        <code>targetType</code> of <code>sclp</code> or <code>sclplm</code>
        (line mode). SCLP is the native console type for s390. There's no
        controller associated to SCLP consoles.
        <span class="since">Since 1.0.2</span>
      </li>
5366
    </ul>
C
Cole Robinson 已提交
5367 5368 5369 5370 5371 5372

    <p>
      A virtio console device is exposed in the
      guest as /dev/hvc[0-7] (for more information, see
      <a href="http://fedoraproject.org/wiki/Features/VirtioSerial">http://fedoraproject.org/wiki/Features/VirtioSerial</a>)
      <span class="since">Since 0.8.3</span>
5373 5374
    </p>

5375 5376 5377 5378 5379 5380 5381
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;console type='pty'&gt;
      &lt;source path='/dev/pts/4'/&gt;
      &lt;target port='0'/&gt;
    &lt;/console&gt;
C
Cole Robinson 已提交
5382 5383 5384 5385 5386 5387

    &lt;!-- KVM virtio console --&gt;
    &lt;console type='pty'&gt;
      &lt;source path='/dev/pts/5'/&gt;
      &lt;target type='virtio' port='0'/&gt;
    &lt;/console&gt;
5388 5389
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
5390

5391 5392 5393 5394 5395 5396 5397 5398 5399 5400 5401
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;!-- KVM s390 sclp console --&gt;
    &lt;console type='pty'&gt;
      &lt;source path='/dev/pts/1'/&gt;
      &lt;target type='sclp' port='0'/&gt;
    &lt;/console&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>

5402 5403 5404 5405 5406 5407
    <p>
      If the console is presented as a serial port, the <code>target</code>
      element has the same attributes as for a serial port. There is usually
      only 1 console.
    </p>

5408 5409 5410 5411 5412 5413 5414
    <h6><a name="elementCharChannel">Channel</a></h6>

    <p>
      This represents a private communication channel between the host and the
      guest.
    </p>

5415 5416 5417 5418 5419 5420 5421
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;channel type='unix'&gt;
      &lt;source mode='bind' path='/tmp/guestfwd'/&gt;
      &lt;target type='guestfwd' address='10.0.2.1' port='4600'/&gt;
    &lt;/channel&gt;
5422 5423 5424 5425 5426

    &lt;!-- KVM virtio channel --&gt;
    &lt;channel type='pty'&gt;
      &lt;target type='virtio' name='arbitrary.virtio.serial.port.name'/&gt;
    &lt;/channel&gt;
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5427 5428
    &lt;channel type='unix'&gt;
      &lt;source mode='bind' path='/var/lib/libvirt/qemu/f16x86_64.agent'/&gt;
5429
      &lt;target type='virtio' name='org.qemu.guest_agent.0' state='connected'/&gt;
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5430
    &lt;/channel&gt;
5431 5432 5433
    &lt;channel type='spicevmc'&gt;
      &lt;target type='virtio' name='com.redhat.spice.0'/&gt;
    &lt;/channel&gt;
5434 5435
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
5436 5437 5438 5439 5440 5441 5442 5443 5444 5445 5446 5447 5448 5449

    <p>
      This can be implemented in a variety of ways. The specific type of
      channel is given in the <code>type</code> attribute of the
      <code>target</code> element. Different channel types have different
      <code>target</code> attributes.
    </p>

    <dl>
      <dt><code>guestfwd</code></dt>
      <dd>TCP traffic sent by the guest to a given IP address and port is
        forwarded to the channel device on the host. The <code>target</code>
        element must have <code>address</code> and <code>port</code> attributes.
        <span class="since">Since 0.7.3</span></dd>
5450 5451 5452

      <dt><code>virtio</code></dt>
      <dd>Paravirtualized virtio channel. Channel is exposed in the guest under
E
Eric Blake 已提交
5453
        /dev/vport*, and if the optional element <code>name</code> is specified,
5454
        /dev/virtio-ports/$name (for more info, please see
E
Eric Blake 已提交
5455 5456
        <a href="http://fedoraproject.org/wiki/Features/VirtioSerial">http://fedoraproject.org/wiki/Features/VirtioSerial</a>). The
        optional element <code>address</code> can tie the channel to a
5457 5458
        particular <code>type='virtio-serial'</code>
        controller, <a href="#elementsAddress">documented above</a>.
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5459 5460 5461 5462
        With qemu, if <code>name</code> is "org.qemu.guest_agent.0",
        then libvirt can interact with a guest agent installed in the
        guest, for actions such as guest shutdown or file system quiescing.
        <span class="since">Since 0.7.7, guest agent interaction
5463
        since 0.9.10</span> Moreover, <span class="since">since 1.0.6</span>
5464 5465 5466 5467
        it is possible to have source path auto generated for virtio unix channels.
        This is very useful in case of a qemu guest agent, where users don't
        usually care about the source path since it's libvirt who talks to
        the guest agent. In case users want to utilize this feature, they should
5468 5469 5470 5471 5472 5473
        leave <code>&lt;source&gt;</code> element out. <span class="since">Since
        1.2.11</span> the active XML for a virtio channel may contain an optional
        <code>state</code> attribute that reflects whether a process in the
        guest is active on the channel. This is an output-only attribute.
        Possible values for the <code>state</code> attribute are
        <code>connected</code> and <code>disconnected</code>.
5474
      </dd>
5475 5476 5477 5478 5479 5480 5481 5482 5483 5484 5485 5486 5487
      <dt><code>spicevmc</code></dt>
      <dd>Paravirtualized SPICE channel. The domain must also have a
        SPICE server as a <a href="#elementsGraphics">graphics
        device</a>, at which point the host piggy-backs messages
        across the <code>main</code> channel.  The <code>target</code>
        element must be present, with
        attribute <code>type='virtio'</code>; an optional
        attribute <code>name</code> controls how the guest will have
        access to the channel, and defaults
        to <code>name='com.redhat.spice.0'</code>.  The
        optional <code>address</code> element can tie the channel to a
        particular <code>type='virtio-serial'</code> controller.
        <span class="since">Since 0.8.8</span></dd>
5488 5489
    </dl>

5490 5491 5492 5493 5494 5495
    <h5><a name="elementsCharHostInterface">Host interface</a></h5>

    <p>
      A character device presents itself to the host as one of the following
      types.
    </p>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5496

5497
    <h6><a name="elementsCharSTDIO">Domain logfile</a></h6>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5498 5499 5500 5501 5502 5503

    <p>
      This disables all input on the character device, and sends output
      into the virtual machine's logfile
    </p>

5504 5505 5506 5507
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;console type='stdio'&gt;
E
Eric Blake 已提交
5508
      &lt;target port='1'/&gt;
5509 5510 5511
    &lt;/console&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5512 5513


5514
    <h6><a name="elementsCharFle">Device logfile</a></h6>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5515 5516 5517 5518 5519 5520

    <p>
      A file is opened and all data sent to the character
      device is written to the file.
    </p>

5521 5522 5523 5524 5525 5526 5527 5528 5529
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;serial type="file"&gt;
      &lt;source path="/var/log/vm/vm-serial.log"/&gt;
      &lt;target port="1"/&gt;
    &lt;/serial&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5530

5531
    <h6><a name="elementsCharVC">Virtual console</a></h6>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5532 5533 5534 5535 5536 5537 5538

    <p>
      Connects the character device to the graphical framebuffer in
      a virtual console. This is typically accessed via a special
      hotkey sequence such as "ctrl+alt+3"
    </p>

5539 5540 5541 5542 5543 5544 5545 5546
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;serial type='vc'&gt;
      &lt;target port="1"/&gt;
    &lt;/serial&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5547

5548
    <h6><a name="elementsCharNull">Null device</a></h6>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5549 5550 5551 5552 5553 5554

    <p>
      Connects the character device to the void. No data is ever
      provided to the input. All data written is discarded.
    </p>

5555 5556 5557 5558 5559 5560 5561 5562
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;serial type='null'&gt;
      &lt;target port="1"/&gt;
    &lt;/serial&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5563

5564
    <h6><a name="elementsCharPTY">Pseudo TTY</a></h6>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5565 5566 5567 5568 5569 5570 5571

    <p>
      A Pseudo TTY is allocated using /dev/ptmx. A suitable client
      such as 'virsh console' can connect to interact with the
      serial port locally.
    </p>

5572 5573 5574 5575 5576 5577 5578 5579 5580
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;serial type="pty"&gt;
      &lt;source path="/dev/pts/3"/&gt;
      &lt;target port="1"/&gt;
    &lt;/serial&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5581 5582 5583

    <p>
      NB special case if &lt;console type='pty'&gt;, then the TTY
A
Atsushi SAKAI 已提交
5584
      path is also duplicated as an attribute tty='/dev/pts/3'
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5585 5586 5587 5588
      on the top level &lt;console&gt; tag. This provides compat
      with existing syntax for &lt;console&gt; tags.
    </p>

5589
    <h6><a name="elementsCharHost">Host device proxy</a></h6>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5590 5591 5592 5593 5594

    <p>
      The character device is passed through to the underlying
      physical character device. The device types must match,
      eg the emulated serial port should only be connected to
A
Atsushi SAKAI 已提交
5595
      a host serial port - don't connect a serial port to a parallel
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5596 5597 5598
      port.
    </p>

5599 5600 5601 5602 5603 5604
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;serial type="dev"&gt;
      &lt;source path="/dev/ttyS0"/&gt;
      &lt;target port="1"/&gt;
E
Eric Blake 已提交
5605
    &lt;/serial&gt;
5606 5607
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5608

5609
    <h6><a name="elementsCharPipe">Named pipe</a></h6>
5610 5611 5612 5613 5614 5615

    <p>
      The character device writes output to a named pipe. See pipe(7) for
      more info.
    </p>

5616 5617 5618 5619 5620 5621 5622 5623 5624
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;serial type="pipe"&gt;
      &lt;source path="/tmp/mypipe"/&gt;
      &lt;target port="1"/&gt;
    &lt;/serial&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
5625

5626
    <h6><a name="elementsCharTCP">TCP client/server</a></h6>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5627 5628 5629

    <p>
      The character device acts as a TCP client connecting to a
5630
      remote server.
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5631 5632
    </p>

5633 5634 5635 5636 5637 5638 5639 5640 5641 5642
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;serial type="tcp"&gt;
      &lt;source mode="connect" host="0.0.0.0" service="2445"/&gt;
      &lt;protocol type="raw"/&gt;
      &lt;target port="1"/&gt;
    &lt;/serial&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
   ...</pre>
5643 5644 5645 5646 5647

    <p>
      Or as a TCP server waiting for a client connection.
    </p>

5648 5649 5650 5651 5652 5653 5654 5655 5656 5657
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;serial type="tcp"&gt;
      &lt;source mode="bind" host="127.0.0.1" service="2445"/&gt;
      &lt;protocol type="raw"/&gt;
      &lt;target port="1"/&gt;
    &lt;/serial&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
5658 5659

    <p>
E
Eric Blake 已提交
5660 5661 5662
      Alternatively you can use <code>telnet</code> instead
      of <code>raw</code> TCP.  <span class="since">Since 0.8.5</span>
      you can also use <code>telnets</code>
5663
      (secure telnet) and <code>tls</code>.
E
Eric Blake 已提交
5664
    </p>
5665

5666 5667 5668 5669 5670 5671 5672 5673 5674 5675 5676 5677 5678 5679 5680 5681
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;serial type="tcp"&gt;
      &lt;source mode="connect" host="0.0.0.0" service="2445"/&gt;
      &lt;protocol type="telnet"/&gt;
      &lt;target port="1"/&gt;
    &lt;/serial&gt;
    ...
    &lt;serial type="tcp"&gt;
      &lt;source mode="bind" host="127.0.0.1" service="2445"/&gt;
      &lt;protocol type="telnet"/&gt;
      &lt;target port="1"/&gt;
    &lt;/serial&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5682

5683
    <h6><a name="elementsCharUDP">UDP network console</a></h6>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5684 5685 5686 5687 5688 5689

    <p>
      The character device acts as a UDP netconsole service,
      sending and receiving packets. This is a lossy service.
    </p>

5690 5691 5692 5693 5694 5695 5696 5697 5698 5699
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;serial type="udp"&gt;
      &lt;source mode="bind" host="0.0.0.0" service="2445"/&gt;
      &lt;source mode="connect" host="0.0.0.0" service="2445"/&gt;
      &lt;target port="1"/&gt;
    &lt;/serial&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5700

5701
    <h6><a name="elementsCharUNIX">UNIX domain socket client/server</a></h6>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5702 5703 5704 5705 5706 5707

    <p>
      The character device acts as a UNIX domain socket server,
      accepting connections from local clients.
    </p>

5708 5709 5710 5711 5712 5713 5714 5715 5716
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;serial type="unix"&gt;
      &lt;source mode="bind" path="/tmp/foo"/&gt;
      &lt;target port="1"/&gt;
    &lt;/serial&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
5717

5718 5719 5720 5721 5722 5723 5724
    <h6><a name="elementsCharSpiceport">Spice channel</a></h6>

    <p>
      The character device is accessible through spice connection
      under a channel name specified in the <code>channel</code>
      attribute.  <span class="since">Since 1.2.2</span>
    </p>
5725 5726 5727 5728 5729
    <p>
      Note: depending on the hypervisor, spiceports might (or might not)
      be enabled on domains with or without <a href="#elementsGraphics">spice
      graphics</a>.
    </p>
5730 5731 5732 5733 5734 5735 5736 5737 5738 5739 5740

<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;serial type="spiceport"&gt;
      &lt;source channel="org.qemu.console.serial.0"/&gt;
      &lt;target port="1"/&gt;
    &lt;/serial&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>

5741 5742 5743 5744
    <h6><a name="elementsNmdm">Nmdm device</a></h6>

    <p>
      The nmdm device driver, available on FreeBSD, provides two
C
Chen Hanxiao 已提交
5745
      tty devices connected together by a virtual null modem cable.
5746 5747 5748 5749 5750 5751 5752 5753 5754 5755 5756 5757 5758 5759 5760 5761 5762 5763
      <span class="since">Since 1.2.4</span>
    </p>

<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;serial type="nmdm"&gt;
      &lt;source master="/dev/nmdm0A" slave="/dev/nmdm0B"/&gt;
    &lt;/serial&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>

    <p>
      The <code>source</code> element has these attributes:
    </p>

    <dl>
      <dt><code>master</code></dt>
5764 5765
      <dd>Master device of the pair, that is passed to the hypervisor.
      Device is specified by a fully qualified path.</dd>
5766 5767 5768

      <dt><code>slave</code></dt>
      <dd>Slave device of the pair, that is passed to the clients for connection
5769
      to the guest console. Device is specified by a fully qualified path.</dd>
5770
    </dl>
5771 5772 5773 5774 5775 5776 5777 5778

    <h4><a name="elementsSound">Sound devices</a></h4>

    <p>
      A virtual sound card can be attached to the host via the
      <code>sound</code> element. <span class="since">Since 0.4.3</span>
    </p>

5779 5780 5781 5782 5783 5784
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;sound model='es1370'/&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
5785 5786 5787 5788 5789 5790 5791

    <dl>
      <dt><code>sound</code></dt>
      <dd>
        The <code>sound</code> element has one mandatory attribute,
        <code>model</code>, which specifies what real sound device is emulated.
        Valid values are specific to the underlying hypervisor, though typical
5792
        choices are 'es1370', 'sb16', 'ac97', 'ich6' and 'usb'.
5793
        (<span class="since">
5794 5795
         'ac97' only since 0.6.0, 'ich6' only since 0.8.8,
         'usb' only since 1.2.7</span>)
5796 5797 5798
      </dd>
    </dl>

5799 5800 5801 5802 5803 5804 5805 5806 5807 5808 5809 5810 5811 5812 5813
    <p>
      <span class="since">Since 0.9.13</span>, a sound element
      with <code>ich6</code> model can have optional
      sub-elements <code>&lt;codec&gt;</code> to attach various audio
      codecs to the audio device. If not specified, a default codec
      will be attached to allow playback and recording. Valid values
      are 'duplex' (advertise a line-in and a line-out) and 'micro'
      (advertise a speaker and a microphone).
    </p>

<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;sound model='ich6'&gt;
      &lt;codec type='micro'/&gt;
M
Michele Paolino 已提交
5814
    &lt;/sound&gt;
5815 5816 5817
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>

E
Eric Blake 已提交
5818 5819 5820
    <p>
      Each <code>sound</code> element has an optional
      sub-element <code>&lt;address&gt;</code> which can tie the
5821 5822
      device to a particular PCI
      slot, <a href="#elementsAddress">documented above</a>.
E
Eric Blake 已提交
5823 5824
    </p>

R
Richard Jones 已提交
5825 5826 5827 5828 5829 5830 5831 5832 5833 5834 5835 5836 5837 5838 5839 5840 5841 5842 5843 5844
    <h4><a name="elementsWatchdog">Watchdog device</a></h4>

    <p>
      A virtual hardware watchdog device can be added to the guest via
      the <code>watchdog</code> element.
      <span class="since">Since 0.7.3, QEMU and KVM only</span>
    </p>

    <p>
      The watchdog device requires an additional driver and management
      daemon in the guest.  Just enabling the watchdog in the libvirt
      configuration does not do anything useful on its own.
    </p>

    <p>
      Currently libvirt does not support notification when the
      watchdog fires.  This feature is planned for a future version of
      libvirt.
    </p>

5845 5846 5847 5848 5849 5850
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;watchdog model='i6300esb'/&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>
R
Richard Jones 已提交
5851

5852 5853 5854 5855 5856 5857
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;watchdog model='i6300esb' action='poweroff'/&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
&lt;/domain&gt;</pre>
R
Richard Jones 已提交
5858 5859 5860 5861

    <dl>
      <dt><code>model</code></dt>
      <dd>
M
Matthew Booth 已提交
5862
        <p>
R
Richard Jones 已提交
5863
        The required <code>model</code> attribute specifies what real
M
Matthew Booth 已提交
5864 5865 5866 5867 5868 5869 5870 5871 5872 5873
        watchdog device is emulated.  Valid values are specific to the
        underlying hypervisor.
        </p>
        <p>
        QEMU and KVM support:
        </p>
        <ul>
          <li> 'i6300esb' &mdash; the recommended device,
            emulating a PCI Intel 6300ESB </li>
          <li> 'ib700' &mdash; emulating an ISA iBase IB700 </li>
5874
          <li> 'diag288' &mdash; emulating an S390 DIAG288 device
5875
            <span class="since">Since 1.2.17</span></li>
M
Matthew Booth 已提交
5876
        </ul>
R
Richard Jones 已提交
5877 5878 5879
      </dd>
      <dt><code>action</code></dt>
      <dd>
M
Matthew Booth 已提交
5880
        <p>
R
Richard Jones 已提交
5881
        The optional <code>action</code> attribute describes what
M
Matthew Booth 已提交
5882 5883 5884 5885 5886 5887 5888 5889 5890 5891 5892 5893 5894
        action to take when the watchdog expires.  Valid values are
        specific to the underlying hypervisor.
        </p>
        <p>
        QEMU and KVM support:
        </p>
        <ul>
          <li>'reset' &mdash; default, forcefully reset the guest</li>
          <li>'shutdown' &mdash; gracefully shutdown the guest
            (not recommended) </li>
          <li>'poweroff' &mdash; forcefully power off the guest</li>
          <li>'pause' &mdash; pause the guest</li>
          <li>'none' &mdash; do nothing</li>
5895 5896
          <li>'dump' &mdash; automatically dump the guest
            <span class="since">Since 0.8.7</span></li>
5897 5898
          <li>'inject-nmi' &mdash; inject a non-maskable interrupt
            into the guest
5899
            <span class="since">Since 1.2.17</span></li>
M
Matthew Booth 已提交
5900 5901
        </ul>
        <p>
5902
        Note 1: the 'shutdown' action requires that the guest
M
Matthew Booth 已提交
5903 5904 5905 5906 5907
        is responsive to ACPI signals.  In the sort of situations
        where the watchdog has expired, guests are usually unable
        to respond to ACPI signals.  Therefore using 'shutdown'
        is not recommended.
        </p>
5908 5909 5910 5911
        <p>
        Note 2: the directory to save dump files can be configured
        by <code>auto_dump_path</code> in file /etc/libvirt/qemu.conf.
        </p>
R
Richard Jones 已提交
5912 5913 5914
      </dd>
    </dl>

5915 5916 5917 5918 5919 5920 5921 5922 5923
    <h4><a name="elementsMemBalloon">Memory balloon device</a></h4>

    <p>
      A virtual memory balloon device is added to all Xen and KVM/QEMU
      guests. It will be seen as <code>memballoon</code> element.
      It will be automatically added when appropriate, so there is no
      need to explicitly add this element in the guest XML unless a
      specific PCI slot needs to be assigned.
      <span class="since">Since 0.8.3, Xen, QEMU and KVM only</span>
5924 5925 5926
      Additionally, <span class="since">since 0.8.4</span>, if the
      memballoon device needs to be explicitly disabled,
      <code>model='none'</code> may be used.
5927 5928 5929
    </p>

    <p>
J
Ján Tomko 已提交
5930
      Example: automatically added device with KVM
5931 5932 5933 5934 5935 5936 5937 5938 5939
    </p>
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;memballoon model='virtio'/&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...</pre>

    <p>
J
Ján Tomko 已提交
5940
      Example: manually added device with static PCI slot 2 requested
5941 5942 5943 5944
    </p>
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
J
Ján Tomko 已提交
5945 5946
    &lt;memballoon model='virtio'&gt;
      &lt;address type='pci' domain='0x0000' bus='0x00' slot='0x02' function='0x0'/&gt;
5947
      &lt;stats period='10'/&gt;
J
Ján Tomko 已提交
5948
    &lt;/memballoon&gt;
5949 5950 5951 5952 5953 5954 5955 5956
  &lt;/devices&gt;
&lt;/domain&gt;</pre>

    <dl>
      <dt><code>model</code></dt>
      <dd>
        <p>
          The required <code>model</code> attribute specifies what type
E
Eric Blake 已提交
5957 5958
          of balloon device is provided. Valid values are specific to
          the virtualization platform
5959 5960 5961 5962 5963 5964
        </p>
        <ul>
          <li>'virtio' &mdash; default with QEMU/KVM</li>
          <li>'xen' &mdash; default with Xen</li>
        </ul>
      </dd>
5965 5966 5967
      <dt><code>period</code></dt>
      <dd>
        <p>
5968 5969 5970 5971 5972 5973 5974 5975 5976 5977 5978
          The optional <code>period</code> allows the QEMU virtio memory balloon
          driver to provide statistics through the <code>virsh dommemstat
          [domain]</code> command. By default, collection is not enabled. In
          order to enable, use the <code>virsh dommemstat [domain] --period
          [number]</code> command or <code>virsh edit</code> command to add the
          option to the XML definition.  The <code>virsh dommemstat</code> will
          accept the options <code>--live</code>, <code>--current</code>,
          or <code>--config</code>.  If an option is not provided, the change
          for a running domain will only be made to the active guest.  If the
          QEMU driver is not at the right revision, the attempt to set the
          period will fail.  Large values (e.g. many years) might be ignored.
5979 5980 5981
          <span class='since'>Since 1.1.1, requires QEMU 1.5</span>
        </p>
      </dd>
5982
    </dl>
5983 5984 5985 5986 5987 5988 5989 5990 5991 5992 5993 5994 5995 5996 5997
    <h4><a name="elementsRng">Random number generator device</a></h4>

    <p>
      The virtual random number generator device allows the host to pass
      through entropy to guest operating systems.
      <span class="since">Since 1.0.3</span>
    </p>

    <p>
      Example: usage of the RNG device:
    </p>
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;rng model='virtio'&gt;
5998
      &lt;rate period="2000" bytes="1234"/&gt;
5999 6000 6001
      &lt;backend model='random'&gt;/dev/random&lt;/backend&gt;
      &lt;!-- OR --&gt;
      &lt;backend model='egd' type='udp'&gt;
6002 6003
        &lt;source mode='bind' service='1234'/&gt;
        &lt;source mode='connect' host='1.2.3.4' service='1234'/&gt;
6004 6005 6006 6007 6008 6009 6010 6011 6012 6013 6014 6015 6016 6017 6018 6019 6020
      &lt;/backend&gt;
    &lt;/rng&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...
</pre>
    <dl>
      <dt><code>model</code></dt>
      <dd>
        <p>
          The required <code>model</code> attribute specifies what type
          of RNG device is provided. Valid values are specific to
          the virtualization platform:
        </p>
        <ul>
          <li>'virtio' &mdash; supported by qemu and virtio-rng kernel module</li>
        </ul>
      </dd>
6021 6022 6023 6024 6025 6026 6027 6028 6029 6030 6031 6032
      <dt><code>rate</code></dt>
      <dd>
        <p>
          The optional <code>rate</code> element allows limiting the rate at
          which entropy can be consumed from the source.  The mandatory
          attribute <code>bytes</code> specifies how many bytes are permitted
          to be consumed per period.  An optional <code>period</code> attribute
          specifies the duration of a period in milliseconds; if omitted, the
          period is taken as 1000 milliseconds (1 second).
          <span class='since'>Since 1.0.4</span>
        </p>
      </dd>
6033 6034 6035 6036 6037 6038 6039 6040
      <dt><code>backend</code></dt>
      <dd>
        <p>
          The <code>backend</code> element specifies the source of entropy
          to be used for the domain. The source model is configured using the
          <code>model</code> attribute. Supported source models are:
        </p>
        <ul>
6041 6042
          <li>'random' &mdash; /dev/random (default) or /dev/hwrng
            device as source (for now, no other sources are permitted)</li>
6043 6044 6045
          <li>'egd' &mdash; a EGD protocol backend</li>
        </ul>
      </dd>
6046
      <dt><code>backend model='random'</code></dt>
6047 6048 6049
      <dd>
        <p>
          This backend type expects a non-blocking character device as input.
6050
          The only accepted paths are /dev/random and /dev/hwrng. The file
6051 6052 6053 6054
          name is specified as contents of the <code>backend</code> element.
          When no file name is specified the hypervisor default is used.
        </p>
      </dd>
6055
      <dt><code>backend model='egd'</code></dt>
6056 6057 6058 6059 6060 6061 6062 6063 6064 6065
      <dd>
        <p>
          This backend connects to a source using the EGD protocol.
          The source is specified as a character device. Refer to
          <a href='#elementsCharHostInterface'>character device host interface</a>
          for more information.
        </p>
      </dd>

    </dl>
6066

6067 6068 6069 6070 6071 6072 6073 6074
    <h4><a name="elementsTpm">TPM device</a></h4>

    <p>
      The TPM device enables a QEMU guest to have access to TPM
      functionality.
    </p>
    <p>
      The TPM passthrough device type provides access to the host's TPM
6075
      for one QEMU guest. No other software may be using the TPM device,
6076 6077 6078 6079 6080 6081 6082 6083 6084 6085 6086 6087
      typically /dev/tpm0, at the time the QEMU guest is started.
      <span class="since">'passthrough' since 1.0.5</span>
    </p>

    <p>
     Example: usage of the TPM passthrough device
    </p>
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;tpm model='tpm-tis'&gt;
      &lt;backend type='passthrough'&gt;
S
Stefan Berger 已提交
6088
        &lt;device path='/dev/tpm0'/&gt;
6089 6090 6091 6092 6093 6094 6095 6096 6097 6098 6099 6100 6101 6102 6103 6104 6105 6106 6107 6108 6109
      &lt;/backend&gt;
    &lt;/tpm&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...
</pre>
    <dl>
      <dt><code>model</code></dt>
      <dd>
        <p>
          The <code>model</code> attribute specifies what device
          model QEMU provides to the guest. If no model name is provided,
          <code>tpm-tis</code> will automatically be chosen.
        </p>
      </dd>
      <dt><code>backend</code></dt>
      <dd>
        <p>
          The <code>backend</code> element specifies the type of
          TPM device. The following types are supported:
        </p>
        <ul>
6110
          <li>'passthrough' &mdash; use the host's TPM device.</li>
6111 6112 6113 6114 6115 6116 6117
        </ul>
      </dd>
      <dt><code>backend type='passthrough'</code></dt>
      <dd>
        <p>
          This backend type requires exclusive access to a TPM device on
          the host.
6118 6119
          An example for such a device is /dev/tpm0. The fully qualified file
          name is specified by path attribute of the <code>source</code> element.
6120 6121 6122 6123 6124
          If no file name is specified then /dev/tpm0 is automatically used.
        </p>
      </dd>
    </dl>

L
Li Zhang 已提交
6125 6126 6127 6128 6129 6130 6131 6132 6133 6134 6135 6136 6137 6138 6139 6140 6141 6142 6143 6144 6145 6146 6147 6148 6149 6150 6151 6152 6153 6154 6155 6156 6157 6158
    <h4><a name="elementsNVRAM">NVRAM device</a></h4>
    <p>
      nvram device is always added to pSeries guest on PPC64, and its address
      is allowed to be changed.  Element <code>nvram</code> (only valid for
      pSeries guest, <span class="since">since 1.0.5</span>) is provided to
      enable the address setting.
    </p>
    <p>
      Example: usage of NVRAM configuration
    </p>
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;nvram&gt;
      &lt;address type='spapr-vio' reg='0x3000'/&gt;
    &lt;/nvram&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...
</pre>
  <dl>
    <dt><code>spapr-vio</code></dt>
    <dd>
      <p>
        VIO device address type, only valid for PPC64.
      </p>
    </dd>
    <dt><code>reg</code></dt>
    <dd>
      <p>
        Device address
      </p>
    </dd>
  </dl>

H
Hu Tao 已提交
6159 6160 6161 6162 6163 6164
    <h4><a name="elementsPanic">panic device</a></h4>
    <p>
      panic device enables libvirt to receive panic notification from a QEMU
      guest.
      <span class="since">Since 1.2.1, QEMU and KVM only</span>
    </p>
6165 6166 6167 6168 6169
    <p>
      For pSeries guests, this feature is always enabled since it's
      implemented by the guest firmware, thus libvirt automatically
      adds the <code>panic</code> element to the domain XML.
    </p>
H
Hu Tao 已提交
6170 6171 6172 6173 6174 6175
    <p>
      Example: usage of panic configuration
    </p>
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
D
Dmitry Andreev 已提交
6176
    &lt;panic model='hyperv'/&gt;
6177
    &lt;panic model='isa'&gt;
H
Hu Tao 已提交
6178 6179 6180 6181 6182 6183
      &lt;address type='isa' iobase='0x505'/&gt;
    &lt;/panic&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...
</pre>
  <dl>
6184 6185 6186 6187 6188 6189 6190 6191 6192 6193 6194 6195 6196 6197
    <dt><code>model</code></dt>
      <dd>
        <p>
          The optional <code>model</code> attribute specifies what type
          of panic device is provided. The panic model used when this attribute
          is missing depends on the hypervisor and guest arch.
        </p>
        <ul>
          <li>'isa' &mdash; for ISA pvpanic device</li>
          <li>'pseries' &mdash; default and valid only for pSeries guests.</li>
          <li>'hyperv' &mdash; for Hyper-V crash CPU feature.
            <span class="since">Since 1.3.0, QEMU and KVM only</span></li>
        </ul>
      </dd>
H
Hu Tao 已提交
6198 6199 6200 6201
    <dt><code>address</code></dt>
    <dd>
      <p>
        address of panic. The default ioport is 0x505. Most users
6202
        don't need to specify an address, and doing so is forbidden
6203
        altogether for pseries and hyperv models.
H
Hu Tao 已提交
6204 6205 6206 6207
      </p>
    </dd>
  </dl>

6208 6209 6210 6211 6212
  <h4><a name="elementsShmem">Shared memory device</a></h4>

    <p>
      A shared memory device allows to share a memory region between
      different virtual machines and the host.
M
Martin Kletzander 已提交
6213
      <span class="since">Since 1.2.10, QEMU and KVM only</span>
6214 6215 6216 6217 6218 6219 6220 6221 6222 6223 6224 6225 6226 6227 6228 6229 6230 6231 6232 6233 6234 6235 6236 6237 6238 6239 6240 6241 6242 6243 6244 6245
    </p>

<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;shmem name='my_shmem0'&gt;
      &lt;size unit='M'&gt;4&lt;/size&gt;
    &lt;/shmem&gt;
    &lt;shmem name='shmem_server'&gt;
      &lt;size unit='M'&gt;2&lt;/size&gt;
      &lt;server path='/tmp/socket-shmem'/&gt;
      &lt;msi vectors='32' ioeventfd='on'/&gt;
    &lt;/shmem&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...
</pre>

  <dl>
    <dt><code>shmem</code></dt>
    <dd>
      The <code>shmem</code> element has one mandatory attribute,
      <code>name</code> to identify the shared memory.
    </dd>
    <dt><code>size</code></dt>
    <dd>
      The optional <code>size</code> element specifies the size of the shared
      memory. This must be power of 2 and greater than or equal to 1 MiB.
    </dd>
    <dt><code>server</code></dt>
    <dd>
      The optional <code>server</code> element can be used to configure a server
      socket the device is supposed to connect to.  The optional
6246 6247
      <code>path</code> attribute specifies the absolute path to the unix socket
      and defaults to <code>/var/lib/libvirt/shmem/$shmem-$name-sock</code>.
6248 6249 6250 6251 6252 6253 6254 6255 6256 6257 6258 6259
    </dd>
    <dt><code>msi</code></dt>
    <dd>
      The optional <code>msi</code> element enables/disables (values "on"/"off",
      respectively) MSI interrupts. This option can currently be used only
      together with the <code>server</code> element. The <code>vectors</code>
      attribute can be used to specify the number of interrupt
      vectors. The <code>ioeventd</code> attribute enables/disables (values
      "on"/"off", respectively) ioeventfd.
    </dd>
  </dl>

6260 6261 6262 6263 6264 6265 6266 6267 6268 6269 6270 6271 6272 6273 6274 6275 6276 6277 6278 6279 6280 6281 6282 6283 6284 6285 6286 6287 6288 6289 6290 6291 6292 6293 6294 6295 6296 6297 6298 6299 6300 6301 6302 6303 6304 6305 6306 6307 6308 6309 6310 6311 6312 6313 6314 6315 6316 6317 6318 6319 6320 6321 6322 6323 6324 6325 6326 6327 6328 6329 6330 6331 6332 6333 6334 6335 6336 6337 6338
    <h4><a name="elementsMemory">Memory devices</a></h4>

    <p>
        In addition to the initial memory assigned to the guest, memory devices
        allow additional memory to be assigned to the guest in the form of
        memory modules.

        A memory device can be hot-plugged or hot-unplugged depending on the
        guests' memory resource needs.

        Some hypervisors may require NUMA configured for the guest.
      <span class="since">Since 1.2.14</span>
    </p>

    <p>
      Example: usage of the memory devices
    </p>
<pre>
  ...
  &lt;devices&gt;
    &lt;memory model='dimm'&gt;
      &lt;target&gt;
        &lt;size unit='KiB'&gt;524287&lt;/size&gt;
        &lt;node&gt;0&lt;/node&gt;
      &lt;/target&gt;
    &lt;/memory&gt;
    &lt;memory model='dimm'&gt;
      &lt;source&gt;
        &lt;pagesize unit='KiB'&gt;4096&lt;/pagesize&gt;
        &lt;nodemask&gt;1-3&lt;/nodemask&gt;
      &lt;/source&gt;
      &lt;target&gt;
        &lt;size unit='KiB'&gt;524287&lt;/size&gt;
        &lt;node&gt;1&lt;/node&gt;
      &lt;/target&gt;
    &lt;/memory&gt;
  &lt;/devices&gt;
  ...
</pre>
    <dl>
      <dt><code>model</code></dt>
      <dd>
        <p>
          Currently only the <code>dimm</code> model is supported in order to
          add a virtual DIMM module to the guest.
        </p>
      </dd>

      <dt><code>source</code></dt>
      <dd>
        <p>
          The optional source element allows to fine tune the source of the
          memory used for the given memory device. If the element is not
          provided defaults configured via <code>numatune</code> are used.
        </p>
        <p>
          <code>pagesize</code> can optionally be used to override the default
          host page size used for backing the memory device.

          The configured value must correspond to a page size supported by the
          host.
        </p>
        <p>
          <code>nodemask</code> can optionally be used to override the default
          set of NUMA nodes where the memory would be allocated.
        </p>
      </dd>

      <dt><code>target</code></dt>
      <dd>
        <p>
          The mandatory <code>target</code> element configures the placement and
          sizing of the added memory from the perspective of the guest.
        </p>
        <p>
          The mandatory <code>size</code> subelement configures the size of the
          added memory as a scaled integer.
        </p>
        <p>
6339 6340 6341
          The <code>node</code> subelement configures the guest NUMA node to
          attach the memory to. The element shall be used only if the guest has
          NUMA nodes configured.
6342 6343 6344 6345
        </p>
      </dd>
    </dl>

6346 6347 6348 6349
    <h3><a name="seclabel">Security label</a></h3>

    <p>
      The <code>seclabel</code> element allows control over the
6350 6351 6352 6353 6354
      operation of the security drivers. There are three basic
      modes of operation, 'dynamic' where libvirt automatically
      generates a unique security label, 'static' where the
      application/administrator chooses the labels, or 'none'
      where confinement is disabled. With dynamic
6355 6356 6357 6358 6359
      label generation, libvirt will always automatically
      relabel any resources associated with the virtual machine.
      With static label assignment, by default, the administrator
      or application must ensure labels are set correctly on any
      resources, however, automatic relabeling can be enabled
6360 6361
      if desired.  <span class="since">'dynamic' since 0.6.1, 'static'
      since 0.6.2, and 'none' since 0.9.10.</span>
6362 6363
    </p>

6364 6365 6366 6367 6368 6369 6370
    <p>
      If more than one security driver is used by libvirt, multiple
      <code>seclabel</code> tags can be used, one for each driver and
      the security driver referenced by each tag can be defined using
      the attribute <code>model</code>
    </p>

6371
    <p>
6372
      Valid input XML configurations for the top-level security label
6373 6374 6375 6376 6377 6378 6379 6380 6381 6382 6383 6384 6385 6386 6387 6388 6389
      are:
    </p>

    <pre>
  &lt;seclabel type='dynamic' model='selinux'/&gt;

  &lt;seclabel type='dynamic' model='selinux'&gt;
    &lt;baselabel&gt;system_u:system_r:my_svirt_t:s0&lt;/baselabel&gt;
  &lt;/seclabel&gt;

  &lt;seclabel type='static' model='selinux' relabel='no'&gt;
    &lt;label&gt;system_u:system_r:svirt_t:s0:c392,c662&lt;/label&gt;
  &lt;/seclabel&gt;

  &lt;seclabel type='static' model='selinux' relabel='yes'&gt;
    &lt;label&gt;system_u:system_r:svirt_t:s0:c392,c662&lt;/label&gt;
  &lt;/seclabel&gt;
6390 6391

  &lt;seclabel type='none'/&gt;
6392 6393
    </pre>

6394 6395 6396 6397 6398 6399 6400
    <p>
      If no 'type' attribute is provided in the input XML, then
      the security driver default setting will be used, which
      may be either 'none' or 'dynamic'. If a 'baselabel' is set
      but no 'type' is set, then the type is presumed to be 'dynamic'
    </p>

6401 6402 6403 6404 6405 6406 6407 6408 6409
    <p>
      When viewing the XML for a running guest with automatic
      resource relabeling active, an additional XML element,
      <code>imagelabel</code>, will be included. This is an
      output-only element, so will be ignored in user supplied
      XML documents
    </p>
    <dl>
      <dt><code>type</code></dt>
6410 6411 6412
      <dd>Either <code>static</code>, <code>dynamic</code> or <code>none</code>
        to determine whether libvirt automatically generates a unique security
        label or not.
6413 6414 6415 6416 6417 6418 6419 6420 6421 6422 6423 6424 6425
      </dd>
      <dt><code>model</code></dt>
      <dd>A valid security model name, matching the currently
        activated security model
      </dd>
      <dt><code>relabel</code></dt>
      <dd>Either <code>yes</code> or <code>no</code>. This must always
        be <code>yes</code> if dynamic label assignment is used. With
        static label assignment it will default to <code>no</code>.
      </dd>
      <dt><code>label</code></dt>
      <dd>If static labelling is used, this must specify the full
        security label to assign to the virtual domain. The format
6426 6427 6428 6429 6430 6431 6432 6433 6434 6435 6436
        of the content depends on the security driver in use:
        <ul>
          <li>SELinux: a SELinux context.</li>
          <li>AppArmor: an AppArmor profile.</li>
          <li>
            DAC: owner and group separated by colon. They can be
            defined both as user/group names or uid/gid. The driver will first
            try to parse these values as names, but a leading plus sign can
            used to force the driver to parse them as uid or gid.
          </li>
        </ul>
6437 6438 6439
      </dd>
      <dt><code>baselabel</code></dt>
      <dd>If dynamic labelling is used, this can optionally be
6440 6441 6442 6443 6444 6445 6446 6447 6448 6449
        used to specify the base security label that will be used to generate
        the actual label. The format of the content depends on the security
        driver in use.

        The SELinux driver uses only the <code>type</code> field of the
        baselabel in the generated label. Other fields are inherited from
        the parent process when using SELinux baselabels.

        (The example above demonstrates the use of <code>my_svirt_t</code>
        as the value for the <code>type</code> field.)
6450 6451 6452 6453 6454 6455 6456 6457
      </dd>
      <dt><code>imagelabel</code></dt>
      <dd>This is an output only element, which shows the
        security label used on resources associated with the virtual domain.
        The format of the content depends on the security driver in use
      </dd>
    </dl>

6458 6459 6460 6461 6462 6463 6464 6465 6466 6467
    <p>When relabeling is in effect, it is also possible to fine-tune
      the labeling done for specific source file names, by either
      disabling the labeling (useful if the file lives on NFS or other
      file system that lacks security labeling) or requesting an
      alternate label (useful when a management application creates a
      special label to allow sharing of some, but not all, resources
      between domains), <span class="since">since 0.9.9</span>.  When
      a <code>seclabel</code> element is attached to a specific path
      rather than the top-level domain assignment, only the
      attribute <code>relabel</code> or the
6468 6469 6470 6471 6472
      sub-element <code>label</code> are supported.  Additionally,
      <span class="since">since 1.1.2</span>, an output-only
      element <code>labelskip</code> will be present for active
      domains on disks where labeling was skipped due to the image
      being on a file system that lacks security labeling.
6473 6474
    </p>

6475 6476 6477 6478 6479 6480 6481 6482 6483 6484 6485 6486 6487 6488 6489 6490 6491 6492 6493 6494 6495 6496 6497 6498 6499 6500 6501 6502 6503 6504 6505 6506 6507 6508 6509 6510 6511 6512 6513
    <h3><a name="keywrap">Key Wrap</a></h3>

       <p>The content of the optional <code>keywrap</code> element specifies
        whether the guest will be allowed to perform the S390 cryptographic key
        management operations. A clear key can be protected by encrypting it
        under a unique wrapping key that is generated for each guest VM running
        on the host. Two variations of wrapping keys are generated: one version
        for encrypting protected keys using the DEA/TDEA algorithm, and another
        version for keys encrypted using the AES algorithm. If a
        <code>keywrap</code> element is not included, the guest will be granted
        access to both AES and DEA/TDEA key wrapping by default.</p>

        <pre>
&lt;domain&gt;
  ...
  &lt;keywrap&gt;
    &lt;cipher name='aes' state='off'/&gt;
  &lt;/keywrap&gt;
  ...
&lt;/domain&gt;
</pre>
    <p>
      At least one <code>cipher</code> element must be nested within the
      <code>keywrap</code> element.
    </p>
    <dl>
      <dt><code>cipher</code></dt>
      <dd>The <code>name</code> attribute identifies the algorithm
        for encrypting a protected key. The values supported for this attribute
        are <code>aes</code> for encryption under the AES wrapping key, or
        <code>dea</code> for encryption under the DEA/TDEA wrapping key. The
        <code>state</code> attribute indicates whether the cryptographic key
        management operations should be turned on for the specified encryption
        algorithm. The value can be set to <code>on</code> or <code>off</code>.
      </dd>
    </dl>

    <p>Note: DEA/TDEA is synonymous with DES/TDES.</p>

D
Daniel P. Berrange 已提交
6514
    <h2><a name="examples">Example configs</a></h2>
6515 6516 6517 6518 6519 6520 6521 6522 6523 6524 6525 6526

    <p>
      Example configurations for each driver are provide on the
      driver specific pages listed below
    </p>

    <ul>
      <li><a href="drvxen.html#xmlconfig">Xen examples</a></li>
      <li><a href="drvqemu.html#xmlconfig">QEMU/KVM examples</a></li>
    </ul>
  </body>
</html>